% \iffalse -*- coding: utf-8 ; -*- \fi % \iffalse meta-comment % % Copyright (C) 2022-2024 by F. Pantigny % ----------------------------------- % % This file may be distributed and/or modified under the % conditions of the LaTeX Project Public License, either version 1.3 % of this license or (at your option) any later version. % The latest version of this license is in: % % http://www.latex-project.org/lppl.txt % % and version 1.3 or later is part of all distributions of LaTeX % version 2005/12/01 or later. % % \fi % \iffalse % %<*batchfile> \begingroup \input l3docstrip.tex \endgroup % % %<@@=piton> %<*driver> \documentclass{l3doc} \usepackage{geometry} \geometry{left=2.8cm,right=2.8cm,top=2.5cm,bottom=2.5cm,papersize={21cm,29.7cm}} \usepackage{fontspec} \usepackage[dvipsnames,svgnames]{xcolor} \usepackage{caption,tabularx,tcolorbox,luacolor,lua-ul,upquote} \def\emphase{\bgroup\color{RoyalPurple}\let\next=} \fvset{commandchars=\~\#\@,formatcom=\color{gray}} \captionsetup{labelfont = bf} \usepackage{ragged2e} \usepackage[footnotehyper]{piton} \PitonOptions { splittable = 4 , math-comments , begin-escape = ! , end-escape = ! , begin-escape-math = \( , end-escape-math = \) , detected-commands = { highLight, footnote } } \parindent 0pt \skip\footins = 2\bigskipamount \def\CC{{C\nolinebreak[4]\hspace{-.05em}\raisebox{.4ex}{\tiny\bfseries ++}}} \usepackage{makeidx} \makeindex \NewDocumentCommand{\indexcommand}{m}{\index{#1@\texttt{\textbackslash #1}}} \NewDocumentCommand{\indexenv}{m}{\index{#1@\texttt{\{#1\}}}} \NewDocumentCommand{\Definition}{m} {{\setlength{\fboxsep}{1pt}\colorbox{gray!20}{\ttfamily \vphantom{gl}#1}}} \NewDocumentCommand{\DefinitionCommand}{m} {{\setlength{\fboxsep}{1pt}\colorbox{gray!20}{\ttfamily \vphantom{gl}\textbackslash #1}}} \PitonOptions{gobble=2} \EnableCrossrefs \begin{document} \DocInput{piton.dtx} \end{document} % % \fi % \iffalse %<*STY> % \fi \def\PitonFileVersion{4.2a} \def\PitonFileDate{2024/12/06} % \iffalse % %<*LUA> piton_version = "4.2a" -- 2024/12/06 % %\fi % % \catcode`\" = 11 % % \title{The package \pkg{piton}\thanks{This document corresponds to the % version~\PitonFileVersion\space of \pkg{piton}, at the date of~\PitonFileDate.}} % \author{F. Pantigny \\ \texttt{fpantigny@wanadoo.fr}} % % \maketitle % % \begin{abstract} % The package \pkg{piton} provides tools to typeset computer listings, with % syntactic highlighting, by using the Lua library LPEG. It requires LuaLaTeX. % \end{abstract} % % \bigskip % {\color{red} Since the version 4.0, the syntax of the absolute and relative % paths used in |\PitonInputFile| has been changed: % cf.~part~\ref{PitonInputFile}, p.~\pageref{PitonInputFile}.} % % % \section{Presentation} % % % The package \pkg{piton} uses the Lua library LPEG\footnote{LPEG is a % pattern-matching library for Lua, written in C, based on \emph{parsing % expression grammars}: % \url{http://www.inf.puc-rio.br/~roberto/lpeg/}} for parsing informatic % listings and typesets them with syntactic highlighting. Since it uses the Lua % of LuaLaTeX, it works with |lualatex| only (and won't work with the other % engines: |latex|, |pdflatex| and |xelatex|). It does not use external program % and the compilation does not require |--shell-escape| (except when the key % |write| is used). The compilation is very fast since all the parsing is done % by the library LPEG, written in C. % % \bigskip % Here is an example of code typeset by \pkg{piton}, with the environment |{Piton}|. % % \bigskip % % \begin{Piton} % from math import pi % % def arctan(x,n=10): % """Compute the mathematical value of arctan(x) % % n is the number of terms in the sum % """ % if x < 0: % return -arctan(-x) # recursive call % elif x > 1: % return pi/2 - arctan(1/x) % #> (we have used that $\arctan(x)+\arctan(1/x)=\frac{\pi}{2}$ for $x>0$)\footnote{This LaTeX escape has been done by beginning the comment by \ttfamily\#>.} % else: % s = 0 % for k in range(n): % s += (-1)**k/(2*k+1)*x**(2*k+1) % return s % \end{Piton} % % % \medskip % The main alternatives to the package \pkg{piton} are probably the packages % \pkg{listings} and \pkg{minted}. % % \medskip % The name of this extension (\pkg{piton}) has been chosen arbitrarily by % reference to the pitons used by the climbers in alpinism. % % % \section{Installation} % % The package \pkg{piton} is contained in two files: |piton.sty| and |piton.lua| % (the LaTeX file |piton.sty| loaded by |\usepackage| will load the Lua file % |piton.lua|). Both files must be in a repertory where LaTeX will be able to % find them, for instance in a |texmf| tree. However, the best is to install % \pkg{piton} with a TeX distribution such as MiKTeX, TeX Live or MacTeX. % % \section{Use of the package} % % The package \pkg{piton} must be used with LuaLaTeX exclusively: if another % LaTeX engine (|latex|, |pdflatex|, |xelatex|,\dots ) is used, a fatal error % will be raised. % % \subsection{Loading the package} % % The package \pkg{piton} should be loaded by: |\usepackage{piton}|. % % \smallskip % If, at the end of the preamble, the package \pkg{xcolor} has not been loaded % (by the final user or by another package), \pkg{piton} loads \pkg{xcolor} with % the instruction |\usepackage{xcolor}| (that is to say without any option). % The package \pkg{piton} doesn't load any other package. It does not any % exterior program. % % \subsection{Choice of the computer language} % % The package \pkg{piton} supports two kinds of languages: % \begin{itemize} % \item the languages natively supported by \pkg{piton}, which are Python, OCaml, % C~(in fact \CC), SQL and a language called |minimal|\footnote{That language % |minimal| may be used to format pseudo-codes: cf. p.~\pageref{minimal}}; % \item the languages defined by the final user by using the built-in command % |\NewPitonLanguage| described p.~\pageref{NewPitonLanguage} (the parsers of % those languages can't be as precise as those of the languages supported % natively by \pkg{piton}). % \end{itemize} % % % \smallskip % By default, the language used is Python. % % \smallskip % \index{language (key)} % It's possible to change the current language with the command |\PitonOptions| % and its key \Definition{language}: |\PitonOptions{language = OCaml}|. % % \smallskip % In fact, for \pkg{piton}, the names of the informatic languages are always % \textbf{case-insensitive}. In this example, we might have written |Ocaml| or % |ocaml|. % % \smallskip % For the developers, let's say that the name of the current language is stored % (in lower case) in the L3 public variable |\l_piton_language_str|. % % \smallskip % In what follows, we will speak of Python, but the features described also % apply to the other languages. % % \subsection{The tools provided to the user} % % \indexenv{Piton} % % The package \pkg{piton} provides several tools to typeset informatic codes: the % command |\piton|, the environment |{Piton}| and the command |\PitonInputFile|. % % \begin{itemize}\setlength{\fboxsep}{1pt} % \item The command \DefinitionCommand{piton} should be used to typeset small % pieces of code inside a paragraph. For example: % % {\color{gray}\verb|\piton{def square(x): return x*x}|}\qquad % \piton{def square(x): return x*x} % % The syntax and particularities of the command |\piton| are detailed below. % % \item The environment \colorbox{gray!20}{\ttfamily\{Piton\}} should be used to % typeset multi-lines code. Since it takes its argument in a verbatim mode, it % can't be used within the argument of a LaTeX command. For sake of % customization, it's possible to define new environments similar to the % environment |{Piton}| with the command |\NewPitonEnvironment|: % cf.~\ref{NewPitonEnvironment} p.~\pageref{NewPitonEnvironment}. % % \item The command \DefinitionCommand{PitonInputFile} is used to insert and % typeset an external file: cf.~\ref{PitonInputFile} % p.~\pageref{PitonInputFile}. % % % \end{itemize} % % \subsection{The syntax of the command \textbackslash piton} % % \indexcommand{piton} % % In fact, the command |\piton| is provided with a double syntax. It may be used % as a standard command of LaTeX taking its argument between curly braces % (|\piton{...}|) but it may also be used with a syntax similar to the syntax of % the command |\verb|, that is to say with the argument delimited by two identical % characters (e.g.: \verb!\piton|...|!). % % \begin{itemize} % \item {\color{blue} \textsf{Syntax} \verb|\piton{...}|}\par\nobreak % When its argument is given between curly braces, the command |\piton| does not % take its argument in verbatim mode. In particular: % \begin{itemize} % \item several consecutive spaces will be replaced by only one space (and the % also the character of end on line), % % {\color{cyan} but the command |\|␣ is provided to force the insertion of a space}; % % \item it's not possible to use |%| inside the argument, % % {\color{cyan} but the command |\%| is provided to insert a |%|}; % % \item the braces must be appear by pairs correctly nested % % {\color{cyan} but the commands |\{| and |\}| are also provided for individual braces}; % % \item the LaTeX commands\footnote{That concerns the commands beginning with a % backslash but also the active characters (with catcode equal to 13). } are % fully expanded and not executed, % % {\color{cyan} so it's possible to use |\\| to insert a backslash}. % \end{itemize} % % % The other characters (including |#|, |^|, |_|, |&|, |$| and |@|) % must be inserted without backslash. % % \bigskip %\begin{tabular}{>{\color{gray}}w{l}{75mm}@{\hspace*{1cm}}l} % \omit Examples : \hfil \\ % \noalign{\vskip1mm} % \verb|\piton{MyString = '\\n'}| & % \piton{MyString = '\\n'} \\ % \verb|\piton{def even(n): return n\%2==0}| & % \piton{def even(n): return n\%2==0} \\ % \verb|\piton{c="#" # an affectation }| & % \piton{c="#" # an affectation } \\ % \verb|\piton{c="#" \ \ \ # an affectation }| & % \piton{c="#" \ \ \ # an affectation } \\ % \verb|\piton{MyDict = {'a': 3, 'b': 4 }}| & % \piton{MyDict = {'a': 3, 'b': 4 }} % \end{tabular} % % \bigskip % It's possible to use the command |\piton| in the arguments of a % LaTeX command.\footnote{For example, it's possible to use the command % \texttt{\textbackslash piton} in a footnote. Example : % \piton{s = 123}.} % % However, since the argument is expanded (in the TeX sens), one should take % care not using in its argument \emph{fragile} commands (that is to say % commands which are neither \emph{protected} nor \emph{fully expandable}). % % \bigskip % \item {\color{blue} \textsf{Syntax} \verb!\piton|...|!}\par\nobreak % % When the argument of the command |\piton| is provided between two identical % characters (all the characters are allowed except |%|, |\|, |#|, |{|, |}| and % the space), that argument is taken in a \emph{verbatim mode}. Therefore, with % that syntax, the command |\piton| can't be used within the argument of another % command. % % \medskip % % \begin{tabular}{>{\color{gray}}w{l}{75mm}@{\hspace*{1cm}}l} % \omit Examples : \hfil \\ % \noalign{\vskip1mm} % \verb!\piton|MyString = '\n'|! & % \piton|MyString = '\n'| \\ % \verb|\piton!def even(n): return n%2==0!| & % \piton!def even(n): return n%2==0! \\ % \verb|\piton+c="#" # an affectation +| & % \piton+c="#" # an affectation + \\ % \verb|\piton?MyDict = {'a': 3, 'b': 4}?| & % \piton!MyDict = {'a': 3, 'b': 4}! % \end{tabular} % % \end{itemize} % % \section{Customization} % % % \subsection{The keys of the command \textbackslash PitonOptions} % % \indexcommand{PitonOptions} % % The command |\PitonOptions| takes in as argument a comma-separated list of % \textsl{key=value} pairs. The scope of the settings done by that command is % the current TeX group.\footnote{We remind that a LaTeX environment is, in % particular, a TeX group.} % % These keys may also be applied to an individual environment |{Piton}| (between % square brackets). % % \begin{itemize} % \item The key \Definition{language} specifies which computer language is % considered (that key is case-insensitive). It's possible to use the name of % the six built-in languages (|Python|, |OCaml|, |C|, |SQL|, |minimal| and % |verbatim|) or the name of a language defined by the user with % |\NewPitonLanguage| (cf.~part~\ref{NewPitonLanguage}, % p.~\pageref{NewPitonLanguage}). % % The initial value is |Python|. % % \item \index{font-command} % \colorbox{yellow!50}{\textbf{New 4.0}}\par\nobreak % % The key \Definition{font-command} contains instructions of font which will be % inserted at the beginning of all the elements composed by \pkg{piton} (without % surprise, these instructions are not used for the so-called ``LaTeX comments''). % % The initial value is |\ttfamily| and, thus, \pkg{piton} uses by default the % current monospaced font. % % \item \index{gobble}\label{gobble} The key \Definition{gobble} takes in as % value a positive integer~$n$: the first $n$ characters are discarded (before % the process of highlighting of the code) for each line of the environment % |{Piton}|. These characters are not necessarily spaces. % % \item \index{auto-gobble}\index{gobble!auto-gobble} When the key % \Definition{auto-gobble} is in force, the extension \pkg{piton} computes the % minimal value $n$ of the number of consecutive spaces beginning each (non % empty) line of the environment |{Piton}| and applies |gobble| with that value % of~$n$. % % \item \index{env-gobble}\index{gobble!env-gobble} % When the key \Definition{env-gobble} is in force, \pkg{piton} analyzes the last % line of the environment |{Piton}|, that is to say the line which contains % |\end{Piton}| and determines whether that line contains only spaces followed % by the |\end{Piton}|. If we are in that situation, \pkg{piton} computes the % number~$n$ of spaces on that line and applies |gobble| with that value of~$n$. % The name of that key comes from \emph{environment gobble}: the effect of % gobble is set by the position of the commands |\begin{Piton}| and % |\end{Piton}| which delimit the current environment. % % \item \index{write} The key \Definition{write} takes in as argument a name of % file (with its extension) and write the content\footnote{In fact, it's not % exactly the body of the environment but the value of |piton.get_last_code()| % which is the body without the overwritten LaTeX formatting instructions (cf. % the part~\ref{API}, p.~\pageref{API}).} of the current environment in % that file. At the first use of a file by \pkg{piton}, it is erased. % % {\bfseries This key requires a compilation with {\ttfamily lualatex % -shell-escape}}. % % \item \index{path-write} The key \Definition{path-write} specifies a path % where the files written by the key |write| will be written. % % \item \index{line-numbers} The key \Definition{line-numbers} activates the % line numbering in the environments |{Piton}| and in the listings resulting % from the use of |\PitonInputFile|. % % In fact, the key |line-numbers| has several subkeys. % \begin{itemize} % \item With the key \Definition{line-numbers/skip-empty-lines}, the empty lines % (which contains only spaces) are considered as non existent for the line % numbering (if the key |/absolute|, described below, is in force, the key % |/skip-empty-lines| is no-op in |\PitonInputFile|). The initial value of that % key is |true| (and not |false|).\footnote{For the language Python, the empty % lines in the docstrings are taken into account (by design).} % \item With the key \Definition{line-numbers/label-empty-lines}, the labels % (that is to say the numbers) of the empty lines are displayed. If the key % |/skip-empty-line| is in force, the clé |/label-empty-lines| is no-op. The % initial value of that key is~|true|.\footnote{When the key % |split-on-empty-lines| is in force, the labels of the empty are never printed.} % \item With the key \Definition{line-numbers/absolute}, in the listings % generated in |\PitonInputFile|, the numbers of the lines displayed are % \emph{absolute} (that is to say: they are the numbers of the lines in the % file). That key may be useful when |\PitonInputFile| is used to insert only a % part of the file (cf. part~\ref{part-of-a-file}, p.~\pageref{part-of-a-file}). % The key |/absolute| is no-op in the environments |{Piton}| and those created % by |\NewPitonEnvironment|. % \item The key \Definition{line-numbers/start} requires that the line numbering % begins to the value of the key. % \item With the key \Definition{line-numbers/resume}, the counter of lines is % not set to zero at the beginning of each environment |{Piton}| or use of % |\PitonInputFile| as it is otherwise. That allows a numbering of the lines % across several environments. % \item The key \Definition{line-numbers/sep} is the horizontal distance between % the numbers of lines (inserted by |line-numbers|) and the beginning of the % lines of code. The initial value is 0.7~em. % \item The key \Definition{line-numbers/format} is a list of tokens which are inserted before % the number of line in order to format it. It's possible to put, \emph{at the % end} of the list, a LaTeX command with one argument, such as, for example, % |\fbox|. % % The initial value is |\footnotesize\color{gray}|. % \end{itemize} % % For convenience, a mechanism of factorisation of the prefix |line-numbers| is % provided. That means that it is possible, for instance, to write: % \begin{Verbatim} % \PitonOptions % { % line-numbers = % { % skip-empty-lines = false , % label-empty-lines = false , % sep = 1 em , % format = \footnotesize \color{blue} % } % } % \end{Verbatim} % % % \item \index{left-margin} The key \Definition{left-margin} corresponds to a % margin on the left. That key may be useful in conjunction with the key % |line-numbers| if one does not want the numbers in an overlapping position on % the left. % % It's possible to use the key |left-margin| with the value |auto|. With that % value, if the key |line-numbers| is in force, a margin will be automatically % inserted to fit the numbers of lines. See an example part % \ref{example-numbering} on page~\pageref{example-numbering}. % % \item \index{background-color} The key \Definition{background-color} sets the % background color of the environments |{Piton}| and the listings produced by % |\PitonInputFile| (it's possible to fix the width of that background with the % key |width| described below). % % \smallskip % The key |background-color| supports also as value a \emph{list} of colors. In % this case, the successive rows are colored by using the colors of the list in % a cyclic way. % % \emph{Example} : |\PitonOptions{background-color = {gray!15,white}}| % % The key |background-color| accepts a color defined «on the fly». For example, % it's possible to write |background-color = [cmyk]{0.1,0.05,0,0}|. % % % \item \index{prompt-background-color} With the key % \Definition{prompt-background-color}, \pkg{piton} adds a % color background to the lines beginning with the prompt ``|>>>|'' (and its % continuation ``|...|'') characteristic of the Python consoles with % \textsc{repl} (\emph{read-eval-print loop}). % % \item \index{width} The key \Definition{width} will fix the width of the % listing. That width applies to the colored backgrounds specified by % |background-color| and |prompt-background-color| but also for the automatic % breaking of the lines (when required by |break-lines|: cf.~\ref{line-breaks}, % p.~\pageref{line-breaks}). % % That key may take in as value a numeric value but also the special % value~|min|. With that value, the width will be computed from the maximal % width of the lines of code. Caution: the special value~|min| requires two % compilations with LuaLaTeX\footnote{The maximal width is computed during the % first compilation, written on the |aux| file and re-used during the second % compilation. Several tools such as |latexmk| (used by Overleaf) do % automatically a sufficient number of compilations.}. % % For an example of use of |width=min|, see the section~\ref{example-comments}, % p.~\pageref{example-comments}. % % % \item \index{show-spaces-in-strings} When the key % \Definition{show-spaces-in-strings} is activated, the spaces in the % strings of characters\footnote{With the language Python that feature applies % only to the short strings (delimited by~\verb|'| or~\verb|"|). In OCaml, that % feature does not apply to the \emph{quoted strings}.} are replaced by the % character~␣ (U+2423 : \textsc{open box}). Of course, that character~U+2423 % must be present in the monospaced font which is used.\footnote{The initial % value of |font-command| is |\ttfamily| and, thus, by default, \pkg{piton} % merely uses the current monospaced font.}\par\nobreak % \begingroup % \PitonOptions{show-spaces-in-strings} Example : % \piton|my_string = 'Very good answer'| \endgroup % % With the key \index{show-spaces} \Definition{show-spaces}, all the spaces are % replaced by U+2423 (and no line break can occur on those ``visible spaces'', % even when the key |break-lines|\footnote{cf. \ref{line-breaks} % p.~\pageref{line-breaks}} is in force). By the way, one should remark that all % the trailing spaces (at the end of a line) are deleted by \pkg{piton}. The % tabulations at the beginning of the lines are represented by arrows. % \end{itemize} % % \bigskip % \begingroup % \fvset{commandchars=\~\&\@,formatcom=\small\color{gray}} % \begin{Verbatim} % ~emphase&\begin{Piton}[language=C,line-numbers,auto-gobble,background-color = gray!15]@ % void bubbleSort(int arr[], int n) { % int temp; % int swapped; % for (int i = 0; i < n-1; i++) { % swapped = 0; % for (int j = 0; j < n - i - 1; j++) { % if (arr[j] > arr[j + 1]) { % temp = arr[j]; % arr[j] = arr[j + 1]; % arr[j + 1] = temp; % swapped = 1; % } % } % if (!swapped) break; % } % } % \end{Piton} % \end{Verbatim} % \endgroup % % \begingroup % \PitonOptions{language=C,line-numbers,gobble=6,background-color = gray!15} % \begin{Piton} % void bubbleSort(int arr[], int n) { % int temp; % int swapped; % for (int i = 0; i < n-1; i++) { % swapped = 0; % for (int j = 0; j < n - i - 1; j++) { % if (arr[j] > arr[j + 1]) { % temp = arr[j]; % arr[j] = arr[j + 1]; % arr[j + 1] = temp; % swapped = 1; % } % } % if (!swapped) break; % } % } % \end{Piton} % \endgroup % % % \bigskip % The command |\PitonOptions| provides in fact several other keys which will be % described further (see in particular the ``Pages breaks and line breaks'' % p.~\pageref{breakable}). % % \subsection{The styles} % % \label{styles} % % \subsubsection{Notion of style} % % The package \pkg{piton} provides the command % \DefinitionCommand{SetPitonStyle} to customize the different styles used to % format the syntactic elements of the informatic listings. The customizations done % by that command are limited to the current TeX group.\footnote{We remind that % a LaTeX environment is, in particular, a TeX group.} % % \bigskip % \indexcommand{SetPitonStyle} % The command |\SetPitonStyle| takes in as argument a comma-separated list of % \textsl{key=value} pairs. The keys are names of styles and the value are LaTeX % formatting instructions. % % \bigskip % These LaTeX instructions must be formatting instructions such as % |\color{...}|, |\bfseries|, |\slshape|, etc. (the commands of this kind are % sometimes called \emph{semi-global} commands). It's also possible to put, % \emph{at the end of the list of instructions}, a LaTeX command taking exactly % one argument. % % \bigskip % Here an example which changes the style used to highlight, in the definition % of a Python function, the name of the function which is defined. That code % uses the command |\highLight| of \pkg{lua-ul} (that package requires also the % package \pkg{luacolor}). % % \begin{verbatim} % \SetPitonStyle{ Name.Function = \bfseries \highLight[red!30] } % \end{verbatim} % % In that example, |\highLight[red!30]| must be considered as the name of a % LaTeX command which takes in exactly one argument, since, usually, it is used % with |\highLight[red!30]{...}|. % % \medskip % \begingroup % \SetPitonStyle % { Name.Function = \bfseries \highLight[red!30] } % With that setting, we will have : \piton{def cube(x) : return x * x * x } % \endgroup % % \bigskip % The different styles, and their use by \pkg{piton} in the different languages % which it supports (Python, OCaml, C, SQL, ``|minimal|'' and ``|verbatim|''), % are described in the part \ref{Semantic}, starting at the page % \pageref{Semantic}. % % % \bigskip % \indexcommand{PitonStyle} % The command \DefinitionCommand{PitonStyle} takes in as argument the name of a % style and allows to retrieve the value (as a list of LaTeX instructions) of % that style. % % \smallskip % For example, it's possible to write |{\PitonStyle{Keyword}{function}}| and we % will have the word {\PitonStyle{Keyword}{function}} formatted as a keyword. % % \smallskip % The syntax |{\PitonStyle{|\textsl{\texttt{style}}|}{...}}| is mandatory in % order to be able to deal both with the semi-global commands and the commands % with arguments which may be present in the definition of the style % \texttt{\textsl{style}}. % % \bigskip % \subsubsection{Global styles and local styles} % % A style may be defined globally with the command |\SetPitonStyle|. That means % that it will apply to all the informatic languages that use that style. % % \bigskip % For example, with the command % \begin{Verbatim} % \SetPitonStyle{Comment = \color{gray}} % \end{Verbatim} % all the comments will be composed in gray in all the listings, whatever % informatic language they use (Python, C, OCaml, etc. or a language defined by % the command |\NewPitonLanguage|). % % \bigskip % But it's also possible to define a style locally for a given informatic % language by providing the name of that language as optional argument (between % square brackets) to the command |\SetPitonStyle|.\footnote{We recall, that, in % the package \pkg{piton}, the names of the informatic languages are % case-insensitive.} % % \bigskip % For example, with the command % \begin{Verbatim} % \SetPitonStyle~emphase#[SQL]@{Keyword = \color[HTML]{006699} \bfseries \MakeUppercase} % \end{Verbatim} % the keywords in the SQL listings will be composed in capital letters, even if % they appear in lower case in the LaTeX source (we recall that, in SQL, the % keywords are case-insensitive). % % \bigskip % As expected, if an informatic language uses a given style and if that style has % no local definition for that language, the global version is used. That notion % of ``global style'' has no link with the notion of global definition in TeX % (the notion of \emph{group} in TeX).\footnote{As regards the TeX groups, the % definitions done by \texttt{\textbackslash SetPitonStyle} are always local.} % % \bigskip % The package \pkg{piton} itself (that is to say the file |piton.sty|) defines % all the styles globally. % % \bigskip % % \subsubsection{The style UserFunction} % % \index{UserFunction (style)} % % The extension \pkg{piton} provides a special style called~|UserFunction|. That % style applies to the names of the functions previously defined by the user % (for example, in Python, these names are those following the keyword % \piton{def} in a previous Python listing). The initial value of that style % |\PitonStyle{Identifier}| and, therefore, the names of the functions are % formatted like the other identifiers (that is to say, by default, with no % special formatting except the features provided in |font-command|). However, % it's possible to change the value of that style, as any other style, with the % command |\SetPitonStyle|. % % \medskip % In the following example, we tune the styles |Name.Function| and |UserFunction| % so as to have clickable names of functions linked to the (informatic) % definition of the function. % % \begingroup % % \NewDocumentCommand{\MyDefFunction}{m}{\hypertarget{piton:#1}{\color[HTML]{CC00FF}{#1}}} % \NewDocumentCommand{\MyUserFunction}{m}{\hyperlink{piton:#1}{#1}} % % \SetPitonStyle % { % Name.Function = \MyDefFunction , % UserFunction = \MyUserFunction % } % % \medskip % \begin{Verbatim} % \NewDocumentCommand{\MyDefFunction}{m} % {\hypertarget{piton:~#1}{\color[HTML]{CC00FF}{~#1}}} % \NewDocumentCommand{\MyUserFunction}{m}{\hyperlink{piton:~#1}{~#1}} % % \SetPitonStyle{Name.Function = \MyDefFunction, ~emphase#UserFunction@ = \MyUserFunction} % \end{Verbatim} % % \smallskip % % \begin{Piton} % def transpose(v,i,j): % x = v[i] % v[i] = v[j] % v[j] = x % % def passe(v): % for in in range(0,len(v)-1): % if v[i] > v[i+1]: % transpose(v,i,i+1) % \end{Piton} % % \endgroup % % \medskip % (Some \textsc{pdf} viewers display a frame around the clickable word % |transpose| but other do not.) % % \PitonClearUserFunctions[Python] % % \bigskip % \begin{small} % Of course, the list of the names of Python functions previously défined is % kept in the memory of LuaLaTeX (in a global way, that is to say independently % of the TeX groups). The extension \pkg{piton} provides a command to clear that % list : it's the command \DefinitionCommand{PitonClearUserFunctions}. When it % is used without argument, that command is applied to all the informatic % languages used by the user but it's also possible to use it with an optional % argument (between square brackets) which is a list of informatic languages to % which the command will be applied.\footnote{We remind that, in \pkg{piton}, % the name of the informatic languages are case-insensitive.} % \end{small} % % \subsection{Creation of new environments} % % \label{NewPitonEnvironment} % \indexcommand{NewPitonEnvironment} % % Since the environment |{Piton}| has to catch its body in a special way (more % or less as verbatim text), it's not possible to construct new environments % directly over the environment |{Piton}| with the classical commands % |\newenvironment| (of standard LaTeX) or |\NewDocumentEnvironment| (of % LaTeX3). % % That's why \pkg{piton} provides a command % \DefinitionCommand{NewPitonEnvironment}. That command takes in three mandatory % arguments. % % That command has the same syntax as the classical environment % |\NewDocumentEnvironment|.\footnote{However, the specifier of argument |b| % (used to catch the body of the environment as a LaTeX argument) is % not allowed.} % % % \bigskip % With the following instruction, a new environment |{Python}| will be % constructed with the same behaviour as |{Piton}|: % % {\color{gray}\verb|\NewPitonEnvironment{Python}{O{}}{\PitonOptions{#1}}{}|} % % \bigskip % If one wishes to format Python code in a box of \pkg{tcolorbox}, it's possible % to define an environment |{Python}| with the following code (of course, the % package \pkg{tcolorbox} must be loaded). % %\begin{verbatim} % \NewPitonEnvironment{Python}{} % {\begin{tcolorbox}} % {\end{tcolorbox}} % \end{verbatim} % % \bigskip % With this new environment |{Python}|, it's possible to write: % % \begin{Verbatim} % ~emphase#\begin{Python}@ % def square(x): % """Compute the square of a number""" % return x*x % ~emphase#\end{Python}@ % \end{Verbatim} % % \NewPitonEnvironment{Python}{} % {\begin{tcolorbox}} % {\end{tcolorbox}} % % \begin{Python} % def square(x): % """Compute the square of a number""" % return x*x % \end{Python} % % \section{Definition of new languages with the syntax of listings} % % \indexcommand{NewPitonLanguage} % \label{NewPitonLanguage} % \index{listings@\pkg{listings} (extension)} % % \medskip % The package \pkg{listings} is a famous LaTeX package to format informatic % listings. % % That package provides a command |\lstdefinelanguage| which allows the user to % define new languages. That command is also used by \pkg{listings} itself to % provide the definition of the predefined languages in \pkg{listings} (in fact, % for this task, \pkg{listings} uses a command called |\lst@definelanguage| but % that command has the same syntax as |\lstdefinelanguage|). % % \medskip % The package \pkg{piton} provides a command % \DefinitionCommand{NewPitonLanguage} to define new languages (available in % |\piton|, |{Piton}|, etc.) with a syntax which is almost the same as the % syntax of~|\lstdefinelanguage|. % % Let's precise that \pkg{piton} does \emph{not} use that command to define the % languages provided natively (Python, OCaml, C, SQL, |minimal| and |verbatim|), % which allows more powerful parsers. % % \medskip % For example, in the file |lstlang1.sty|, which is one of the definition files % of \pkg{listings}, we find the following instructions (in version 1.10a). % %\begin{Verbatim}[formatcom=\small\color{gray}] % \lst~@definelanguage{Java}% % {morekeywords={abstract,boolean,break,byte,case,catch,char,class,% % const,continue,default,do,double,else,extends,false,final,% % finally,float,for,goto,if,implements,import,instanceof,int,% % interface,label,long,native,new,null,package,private,protected,% % public,return,short,static,super,switch,synchronized,this,throw,% % throws,transient,true,try,void,volatile,while},% % sensitive,% % morecomment=[l]//,% % morecomment=[s]{/*}{*/},% % morestring=[b]",% % morestring=[b]',% % }[keywords,comments,strings] % \end{Verbatim} % % \medskip % In order to define a language called |Java| for \pkg{piton}, one has only to % write the following code {\bfseries where the last argument of % |\lst@definelanguage|, between square brackets, has been discarded} (in fact, % the symbols \verb+%+ may be deleted without any problem). % % \begin{Verbatim}[formatcom=\small\color{gray}] % ~emphase#\NewPitonLanguage@{Java}% % {morekeywords={abstract,boolean,break,byte,case,catch,char,class,% % const,continue,default,do,double,else,extends,false,final,% % finally,float,for,goto,if,implements,import,instanceof,int,% % interface,label,long,native,new,null,package,private,protected,% % public,return,short,static,super,switch,synchronized,this,throw,% % throws,transient,true,try,void,volatile,while},% % sensitive,% % morecomment=[l]//,% % morecomment=[s]{/*}{*/},% % morestring=[b]",% % morestring=[b]',% % } % \end{Verbatim} % % % \NewPitonLanguage{Java} % {morekeywords={abstract,boolean,break,byte,case,catch,char,class, % const,continue,default,do,double,else,extends,false,final, % finally,float,for,goto,if,implements,import,instanceof,int, % interface,label,long,native,new,null,package,private,protected, % public,return,short,static,super,switch,synchronized,this,throw, % throws,transient,true,try,void,volatile,while}, % sensitive, % morecomment=[l]//, % morecomment=[s]{/*}{*/}, % morestring=[b]", % morestring=[b]', % } % % \medskip % It's possible to use the language Java like any other language defined by % \pkg{piton}. % % Here is an example of code formatted in an environment |{Piton}| with % the key |language=Java|.\footnote{We recall that, for \pkg{piton}, the names % of the informatic languages are case-insensitive. Hence, it's possible to % write, for instance, |language=java|.} % % % \bigskip % \begingroup % \small % \PitonOptions{splittable-on-empty-lines} % \begin{Piton}[language = java] % public class Cipher { // Caesar cipher % public static void main(String[] args) { % String str = "The quick brown fox Jumped over the lazy Dog"; % System.out.println( Cipher.encode( str, 12 )); % System.out.println( Cipher.decode( Cipher.encode( str, 12), 12 )); % } % % public static String decode(String enc, int offset) { % return encode(enc, 26-offset); % } % % public static String encode(String enc, int offset) { % offset = offset % 26 + 26; % StringBuilder encoded = new StringBuilder(); % for (char i : enc.toCharArray()) { % if (Character.isLetter(i)) { % if (Character.isUpperCase(i)) { % encoded.append((char) ('A' + (i - 'A' + offset) % 26 )); % } else { % encoded.append((char) ('a' + (i - 'a' + offset) % 26 )); % } % } else { % encoded.append(i); % } % } % return encoded.toString(); % } % } % \end{Piton} % \endgroup % % \bigskip % The keys of the command |\lstdefinelanguage| of \pkg{listings} supported by |\NewPitonLanguage| are: % |morekeywords|, |otherkeywords|, |sensitive|, |keywordsprefix|, |moretexcs|, % |morestring| (with the letters |b|, % |d|, |s| and |m|), |morecomment| (with the letters |i|, |l|, |s| and |n|), % |moredelim| (with the letters |i|, % |l|, |s|, |*| and |**|), |moredirectives|, |tag|, |alsodigit|, |alsoletter| % and |alsoother|. % % For the description of those keys, we redirect the reader to the documentation % of the package \pkg{listings} (type |texdoc| |listings| in a terminal). % % \bigskip % For example, here is a language called ``LaTeX'' to format LaTeX chunks of codes: % \begin{Verbatim} % \NewPitonLanguage{LaTeX}{keywordsprefix = \ , alsoletter = ~@_ } % \end{Verbatim} % % Initially, the characters |@| and |_| are considered as letters because, in % many informatic languages, they are allowed in the keywords and the names of % the identifiers. With \verb|alsoletter = @_|, we retrieve them from the % category of the letters. % % \section{Advanced features} % \subsection{Insertion of a file} % % \label{PitonInputFile} % % \subsubsection{The command \textbackslash PitonInputFile} % % \indexcommand{PitonInputFile} % % The command \DefinitionCommand{PitonInputFile} includes the content of the % file specified in argument (or only a part of that file: see below). The % extension \pkg{piton} also provides the commands % \DefinitionCommand{PitonInputFileT}, \DefinitionCommand{PitonInputFileF} and % \DefinitionCommand{PitonInputFileTF} with supplementary arguments % corresponding to the letters~|T| and~|F|. Those arguments will be executed if % the file to include has been found (letter~|T|) or not found (letter~|F|). % % \bigskip % \colorbox{yellow!50}{\textbf{Modification 4.0}}\par\nobreak % % \index{old-PitonInputFile} % \smallskip % The syntax for the absolute and relative paths has been changed in order to % be conform to the traditionnal usages. However, it's possible to use the key % \Definition{old-PitonInputFile} at load-time (that is to say with the % |\usepackage|) in order to have the old behaviour (though, that key will be % deleted in a future version of \pkg{piton}!). % % \smallskip % Now, the syntax is the following one: % \begin{itemize} % \item The paths beginning by |/| are absolute. % % \emph{Example} : |\PitonInputFile{/Users/joe/Documents/program.py}| % % \item The paths which do not begin with |/| are relative to the current % repertory. % % \emph{Example} : |\PitonInputFile{my_listings/program.py}| % \end{itemize} % % \index{path} % The key \Definition{path} of the command |\PitonOptions| specifies a % \emph{list} of paths where the files included by |\PitonInputFile| will be % searched. That list is comma separated. % % As previously, the absolute paths must begin with |/|. % % \bigskip % \subsubsection{Insertion of a part of a file} % % \label{part-of-a-file} % \indexcommand{PitonInputFile} % % The command |\PitonInputFile| inserts (with formatting) the content of a file. % In fact, it's possible to insert only \emph{a part} of that file. Two % mechanisms are provided in this aim. % \begin{itemize} % \item It's possible to specify the part that we want to insert by the numbers % of the lines (in the original file). % \item It's also possible to specify the part to insert with textual markers. % \end{itemize} % In both cases, if we want to number the lines with the numbers of the % lines in the file, we have to use the key |line-numbers/absolute|. % % \bigskip % \textbf{With line numbers}\par\nobreak % % The command |\PitonInputFile| supports the keys \Definition{first-line} and % \Definition{last-line} in order to insert only the part of file between the % corresponding lines. Not to be confused with the key |line-numbers/start| % which fixes the first line number for the line numbering. In a sens, % |line-numbers/start| deals with the output whereas |first-line| and % |last-line| deal with the input. % % \bigskip % \textbf{With textual markers}\par\nobreak % % \index{marker/beginning} % \index{marker/end} % % In order to use that feature, we first have to specify the format of the % markers (for the beginning and the end of the part to include) with the keys % \Definition{marker-beginning} and \Definition{marker-end} (usually with the % command |\PitonOptions|). % % % \medskip % Let us take a practical example. % % \medskip % We assume that the file to include contains solutions to exercises of % programmation on the following model. % % \begin{Verbatim}[formatcom=\small\color{gray}] % ~#[Exercise 1] Iterative version % def fibo(n): % if n==0: return 0 % else: % u=0 % v=1 % for i in range(n-1): % w = u+v % u = v % v = w % return v % ~# % \end{Verbatim} % % The markers of the beginning and the end are the strings |#[Exercise 1]| and % |#|. The string ``|Exercise 1|'' will be called the \emph{label} % of the exercise (or of the part of the file to be included). % % In order to specify such markers in \pkg{piton}, we will use the keys % |marker/beginning| and |marker/end| with the following instruction (the % character |#| of the comments of Python must be inserted with the protected % form |\#|). % % \begin{Verbatim} % \PitonOptions{ ~emphase#marker/beginning@ = \~#[~#1] , ~emphase#marker/end@ = \~#<~#1> } % \end{Verbatim} % % As one can see, |marker/beginning| is an expression corresponding to the % mathematical function which transforms the label (here |Exercise 1|) into the % the beginning marker (in the example |#[Exercise 1]|). The string |#1| % corresponds to the occurrences of the argument of that function, which the % classical syntax in TeX. Idem for |marker/end|. % % \bigskip % Now, you only have to use the key \Definition{range} of |\PitonInputFile| to % insert a marked content of the file. % % \smallskip % \begin{Verbatim} % \PitonInputFile[~emphase#range = Exercise 1@]{~textsl#file_name@} % \end{Verbatim} % % \medskip % \begin{Piton} % def fibo(n): % if n==0: return 0 % else: % u=0 % v=1 % for i in range(n-1): % w = u+v % u = v % v = w % return v % \end{Piton} % % \vspace{1cm} % \index{marker/include-lines} % The key \Definition{marker/include-lines} requires the insertion of the lines % containing the markers. % % \begin{Verbatim} % \PitonInputFile[~emphase#marker/include-lines@,range = Exercise 1]{~textsl#file_name@} % \end{Verbatim} % % \begin{Piton} % #[Exercise 1] Iterative version % def fibo(n): % if n==0: return 0 % else: % u=0 % v=1 % for i in range(n-1): % w = u+v % u = v % v = w % return v % # % \end{Piton} % % % \bigskip % \index{begin-range} % \index{end-range} % In fact, there exist also the keys \Definition{begin-range} and % \Definition{end-range} to insert several marked contents at the same time. % % For example, in order to insert the solutions of the exercises~3 to~5, we will % write (if the file has the correct structure!): % % % \begin{Verbatim} % \PitonInputFile[~emphase#begin-range = Exercise 3, end-range = Exercise 5@]{~textsl#file_name@} % \end{Verbatim} % % % % \bigskip % \subsection{Page breaks and line breaks} % % \label{breakable} % % \subsubsection{Line breaks} % % \label{line-breaks} % % By default, the elements produced by \pkg{piton} can't be broken by an end on % line. However, there are keys to allow such breaks (the possible breaking % points are the spaces, even the spaces which appear in the strings of the % informatic languages). % \begin{itemize} % \item \index{break-lines!break-lines-in-piton} With the key % \Definition{break-lines-in-piton}, the line breaks are allowed in the command % |\piton{...}| (but not in the command \verb+\piton|...|+, that is to say the % command |\piton| in verbatim mode). % \item \index{break-lines!break-lines-in-Piton} With the key % \Definition{break-lines-in-Piton}, the line breaks are allowed in the % environment |{Piton}| (hence the capital letter |P| in the name) and in the % listings produced by |\PitonInputFile|. % \item \index{break-lines} The key \Definition{break-lines} is a conjunction of % the two previous keys. % \end{itemize} % % \bigskip % The package \pkg{piton} provides also several keys to control the appearance % on the line breaks allowed by |break-lines-in-Piton|. % % \begin{itemize} % \item \index{indent-broken-lines} With the key % \Definition{indent-broken-lines}, the indentation of a % broken line is respected at carriage return (on the condition that the used % font is a monospaced font and this is the case by default since the initial % value of |font-command| is |\ttfamily|). % % \item The key \Definition{end-of-broken-line} corresponds to the symbol placed % at the end of a broken line. The initial value is: % |\hspace*{0.5em}\textbackslash|. % % \item \index{continuation-symbol} The key \Definition{continuation-symbol} % corresponds to the symbol placed at each carriage return. The initial value % is: |+\;| (the command |\;| inserts a small horizontal space). % % \item \index{continuation-symbol-on-indentation} % The key \Definition{continuation-symbol-on-indentation} corresponds to % the symbol placed at each carriage return, on the position of the indentation % (only when the key |indent-broken-line| is in force). The initial value is: % |$\hookrightarrow\;$|. % \end{itemize} % % % \bigskip % The following code has been composed with the following tuning: % % \begin{Verbatim} % \PitonOptions{width=12cm,break-lines,indent-broken-lines,background-color=gray!15} % \end{Verbatim} % % \begin{center} % \PitonOptions{width=12cm,break-lines,indent-broken-lines,background-color=gray!15} % \begin{Piton} % def dict_of_list(l): % """Converts a list of subrs and descriptions of glyphs in a dictionary""" % our_dict = {} % for list_letter in l: % if (list_letter[0][0:3] == 'dup'): # if it's a subr % name = list_letter[0][4:-3] % print("We treat the subr of number " + name) % else: % name = list_letter[0][1:-3] # if it's a glyph % print("We treat the glyph of number " + name) % our_dict[name] = [treat_Postscript_line(k) for k in list_letter[1:-1]] % return dict % \end{Piton} % \end{center} % % \bigskip % \colorbox{yellow!50}{\bfseries{New 4.1}}\par\nobreak % % \smallskip % With the key \Definition{break-strings-anywhere}, the strings may be broken % anywhere (and not only on the spaces). % % \bigskip % \colorbox{yellow!50}{\bfseries{New 4.2}}\par\nobreak % % \smallskip % With the key \Definition{break-numbers-anywhere}, the numbers may be broken % anywhere. % % \subsubsection{Page breaks} % \label{page breaks} % \index{splittable} % \index{splittable-on-empty-lines} % % By default, the listings produced by the environment |{Piton}| and the command % |\PitonInputFile| are not breakable. % % However, \pkg{piton} provides the keys |splittable-on-empty-lines| and % |splittable| to allow such breaks. % % \begin{itemize} % \item The key \Definition{splittable-on-empty-lines} allows breaks on the empty % lines. The ``empty lines'' are in fact the lines which contains only spaces. % % \item Of course, the key |splittable-on-empty-lines| may not be sufficient and % that's why \pkg{piton} provides the key \Definition{splittable}. % % When the key |splittable| is used with the numeric value~$n$ (which must be a % positive integer) the listing, or each part of the listing delimited by empty % lines (when |split-on-empty-lines| is in force) may be broken anywhere with % the restriction that no break will occur within the $n$ first lines of % the listing or within the $n$ last lines.\footnote{Remark that we speak of the % lines of the original informatic listing and such line may be composed on % several lines in the final \textsc{pdf} when the key |break-lines-in-Piton| is % in force.} % % For example, a tuning with |splittable = 4| may be a good choice. % % When used without value, the key |splittable| is equivalent to % |splittable = 1| and the listings may be broken anywhere (it's probably % not recommandable). % % The initial value of the key |splittable| is equal to 100 (by default, the % listings are not breakable at all). % \end{itemize} % % \medskip % Even with a background color (set by the key |background-color|), the pages % breaks are allowed, as soon as the key |split-on-empty-lines| or the key % |splittable| is in force.\footnote{With the key |splittable|, the environments % \texttt{\{Piton\}} are breakable, even within a (breakable) environment of % \pkg{tcolorbox}. Remind that an environment of \pkg{tcolorbox} included in % another environment of \pkg{tcolorbox} is \emph{not} breakable, even when both % environments use the key |breakable| of \pkg{tcolorbox}.} % % \subsection{Splitting of a listing in sub-listings} % % \index{split-on-empty-lines} % \label{split-on-empty-lines} % \index{split-separation} % % The extension \pkg{piton} provides the key \Definition{split-on-empty-lines}, % which should not be confused with the key |splittable-on-empty-lines| % previously defined. % % \smallskip % In order to understand the behaviour of the key |split-on-empty-lines|, one % should imagine that he has to compose an informatic listing which contains % several definitions of informatic functions. Usually, in the informatic % languages, those definitions of functions are separated by empty lines. % % \smallskip % The key |split-on-empty-lines| splits the listings on the empty lines. Several % empty lines are deleted and replaced by the content of the parameter % corresponding to the key \Definition{split-separation}. % \begin{itemize} % \item That parameter must contain elements allowed to be inserted in % \emph{vertical mode} of TeX. For example, it's possible to put the TeX % primitive |\hrule|. % % \item The initial value of this parameter is % |\vspace{\baselineskip}\vspace{-1.25pt}| which corresponds eventually to an % empty line in the final \textsc{pdf} (this vertical space is deleted if it % occurs on a page break). If the key |background-color| is in force, no % background color is added to that empty line. % \end{itemize} % % % \colorbox{yellow!50}{\textbf{New 4.0}}\par\nobreak % Each chunk of the informatic listing is composed in an environment whose name % is given by the key \Definition{env-used-by-split}. The initial value of that % parameter is, not surprisingly, |Piton| and, hence, the different chunks are % composed in several environments |{Piton}|. If one decides to change the value % of |env-used-by-split|, he should use the name of an environment created by % |\NewPitonEnvironment| (cf.~part~\ref{NewPitonEnvironment}, % p.~\pageref{NewPitonEnvironment}). % % Each chunk of the informatic listing is formated in its own environment. % Therefore, it has its own line numbering (if the key % |line-numbers| is in force) and its own colored background (when the key % |background-color| is in force), separated from the background color of the % other chunks. When used, the key |splittable| applies in each chunk % (independently of the other chunks). Of course, a page break may occur between % the chunks of code, regardless of the value of |splittable|. % % \bigskip % \begin{Verbatim} % \begin{Piton}[~emphase#split-on-empty-lines@,background-color=gray!15,line-numbers] % def square(x): % """Computes the square of x""" % return x*x % % def cube(x): % """Calcule the cube of x""" % return x*x*x % \end{Piton} % \end{Verbatim} % % % \begin{Piton}[split-on-empty-lines,background-color=gray!15,line-numbers] % def square(x): % """Computes the square of x""" % return x*x % % def cube(x): % """Calcule the cube of x""" % return x*x*x % \end{Piton} % % \bigskip % \textbf{Caution}: Since each chunk is treated independently of the others, the % commands specified by |detected-commands| and the commands and environments % of Beamer automatically detected by \pkg{piton} must not cross the enmpty % lines of the original listing. % % \subsection{Highlighting some identifiers} % % \label{SetPitonIdentifier} % % The command \DefinitionCommand{SetPitonIdentifier} allows to change the % formatting of some identifiers. % % \smallskip % That command takes in three arguments: % % \begin{itemize} % \item The optional argument (within square brackets) specifies the informatic % language. If this argument is not present, the tunings done by % |\SetPitonIdentifier| will apply to all the informatic languages of % \pkg{piton}.\footnote{We recall, that, in the package \pkg{piton}, the % names of the informatic languages are case-insensitive.} % % \item The first mandatory argument is a comma-separated list of names of % identifiers. % % \item The second mandatory argument is a list of LaTeX instructions of the % same type as \pkg{piton} ``styles'' previously presented (cf.~\ref{styles} % p.~\pageref{styles}). % \end{itemize} % % \emph{Caution}: Only the identifiers may be concerned by that key. The % keywords and the built-in functions won't be affected, even if their name % appear in the first argument of the command |\SetPitonIdentifier|. % % \begin{Verbatim} % ~emphase#\SetPitonIdentifier{l1,l2}{\color{red}}@ % \begin{Piton} % def tri(l): % """Segmentation sort""" % if len(l) <= 1: % return l % else: % a = l[0] % l1 = [ x for x in l[1:] if x < a ] % l2 = [ x for x in l[1:] if x >= a ] % return tri(l1) + [a] + tri(l2) % \end{Piton} % \end{Verbatim} % % % \bigskip % % \begingroup % % \SetPitonIdentifier{l1,l2}{\color{red}} % % \begin{Piton} % def tri(l): % """Segmentation sort""" % if len(l) <= 1: % return l % else: % a = l[0] % l1 = [ x for x in l[1:] if x < a ] % l2 = [ x for x in l[1:] if x >= a ] % return tri(l1) + [a] + tri(l2) % \end{Piton} % % \endgroup % % \bigskip % By using the command |\SetPitonIdentifier|, it's possible to add other % built-in functions (or other new keywords, etc.) that will be detected by % \pkg{piton}. % % % \begin{Verbatim} % ~emphase#\SetPitonIdentifier[Python]@ % {cos, sin, tan, floor, ceil, trunc, pow, exp, ln, factorial} % {\PitonStyle{Name.Builtin}} % % \begin{Piton} % from math import * % cos(pi/2) % factorial(5) % ceil(-2.3) % floor(5.4) % \end{Piton} % \end{Verbatim} % % \begingroup % % \SetPitonIdentifier[Python] % {cos, sin, tan, floor, ceil, trunc, pow, exp, ln, factorial} % {\PitonStyle{Name.Builtin}} % % \begin{Piton} % from math import * % cos(pi/2) % factorial(5) % ceil(-2.3) % floor(5.4) % \end{Piton} % % % \endgroup % % % \subsection{Mechanisms to escape to LaTeX} % % \index{escapes to LaTeX} % % The package \pkg{piton} provides several mechanisms for escaping to LaTeX: % \begin{itemize} % \item It's possible to compose comments entirely in LaTeX. % \item It's possible to have the elements between \texttt{\$} in the comments % composed in LateX mathematical mode. % \item It's possible to ask \pkg{piton} to detect automatically some LaTeX % commands, thanks to the key |detected-commands|. % \item It's also possible to insert LaTeX code almost everywhere in a Python listing. % \end{itemize} % % One should also remark that, when the extension \pkg{piton} is used with the % class \cls{beamer}, \pkg{piton} detects in |{Piton}| many commands and % environments of Beamer: cf. \ref{beamer} p.~\pageref{beamer}. % % \subsubsection{The ``LaTeX comments''} % % \index{comment-latex} % % In this document, we call ``LaTeX comments'' the comments which begins by % |#>|. The code following those characters, until the end of the line, will be % composed as standard LaTeX code. There is two tools to customize those % comments. % % \begin{itemize} % \item It's possible to change the syntactic mark (which, by default, is |#>|). % For this purpose, there is a key \Definition{comment-latex} available only in % the preamble of the document, allows to choice the characters which, preceded % by |#|, will be the syntactic marker. % % For example, if the preamble contains the following instruction: % % \quad \verb|\PitonOptions{comment-latex = LaTeX}| % % the LaTeX comments will begin by |#LaTeX|. % % If the key |comment-latex| is used with the empty value, all the Python % comments (which begins by |#|) will, in fact, be ``LaTeX comments''. % % \smallskip % \item It's possible to change the formatting of the LaTeX comment itself by % changing the \pkg{piton} style |Comment.LaTeX|. % % For example, with |\SetPitonStyle{Comment.LaTeX = \normalfont\color{blue}}|, % the LaTeX comments will be composed in blue. % % If you want to have a character |#| at the beginning of the LaTeX comment in % the \textsc{pdf}, you can use set |Comment.LaTeX| as follows: % % \begin{Verbatim} % \SetPitonStyle{Comment.LaTeX = \color{gray}\~#\normalfont\space } % \end{Verbatim} % % For other examples of customization of the LaTeX comments, see the part % \ref{example-comments} p.~\pageref{example-comments} % \end{itemize} % % \bigskip % If the user has required line numbers (with the key |line-numbers|), it's % possible to refer to a number of line with the command |\label| used in a % LaTeX comment.\footnote{That feature is implemented by using a redefinition of % the standard command \texttt{\textbackslash label} in the environments % \texttt{\{Piton\}}. Therefore, incompatibilities may occur with extensions % which redefine (globally) that command \texttt{\textbackslash label} (for % example: \pkg{varioref}, \pkg{refcheck}, \pkg{showlabels}, etc.)} % % \subsubsection{The key ``math-comments''} % % \index{math-comments} % % It's possible to request that, in the standard Python comments (that is to say % those beginning by |#| and not |#>|), the elements between \texttt{\$} be % composed in LaTeX mathematical mode (the other elements of the comment being % composed verbatim). % % That feature is activated by the key \Definition{math-comments}, \emph{which is % available only in the preamble of the document}. % % \medskip % Here is a example, where we have assumed that the preamble of the document % contains the instruction |\PitonOptions{math-comment}|: % % \begin{Verbatim} % \begin{Piton} % def square(x): % return x*x ~# compute $x^2$ % \end{Piton} % \end{Verbatim} % % \begin{Piton} % def square(x): % return x*x # compute $x^2$ % \end{Piton} % % \subsubsection{The key ``detected-commands''} % % \index{detected-commands (key)} % \label{detected-commands} % % The key \Definition{detected-commands} of |\PitonOptions| allows to specify a % (comma-separated) list of names of LaTeX commands that will be detected % directly by \pkg{piton}. % % \begin{itemize} % \item The key |detected-commands| must be used in the preamble of the LaTeX document. % % \item The names of the LaTeX commands must appear without the leading % backslash (eg. |detected-commands = { emph, textbf }|). % % \item These commands must be LaTeX commands with only one (mandatory) argument % between braces (and these braces must appear explicitly in the informatic listing). % \end{itemize} % % \bigskip % In the following example, which is a recursive programmation of the factorial % function, we decide to highlight the recursive call. The command |\highLight| % of \pkg{lua-ul}\footnote{The package \pkg{lua-ul} requires itself the package % \pkg{luacolor}.} directly does the job with the easy syntax |\highLight{...}|. % % \medskip % We assume that the preamble of the LaTeX document contains the following line: % \begin{Verbatim} % \PitonOptions{~emphase#detected-commands@ = highLight} % \end{Verbatim} % % Then, it's possible to write directly: % \begin{Verbatim} % \begin{Piton} % def fact(n): % if n==0: % return 1 % else: % ~emphase#\highLight@{return n*fact(n-1)} % \end{Piton} % \end{Verbatim} % % \begin{Piton} % def fact(n): % if n==0: % return 1 % else: % \highLight{return n*fact(n-1)} % \end{Piton} % % % \subsubsection{The mechanism ``escape''} % % \label{escape} % % It's also possible to overwrite the informatic listings to insert LaTeX code % almost everywhere (but between lexical units, of course). By default, % \pkg{piton} does not fix any delimiters for that kind of escape. % % In order to use this mechanism, it's necessary to specify the delimiters which % will delimit the escape (one for the beginning and one for the end) by using % the keys \Definition{begin-escape} and \Definition{end-escape}, \emph{available only % in the preamble of the document}. % % \medskip % We consider once again the previous example of a recursive programmation of % the factorial. We want to highlight in pink the instruction containing the % recursive call. With the package \pkg{lua-ul}, we can use the syntax % |\highLight[LightPink]{...}|. Because of the optional argument between square % brackets, it's not possible to use the key |detected-commands| but it's % possible to achieve our goal with the more general mechanism ``escape''. % % \medskip % We assume that the preamble of the document contains the following % instruction: % % \begin{Verbatim} % \PitonOptions{~emphase#begin-escape=!,end-escape=!@} % \end{Verbatim} % % \medskip % Then, it's possible to write: % \begin{Verbatim} % \begin{Piton} % def fact(n): % if n==0: % return 1 % else: % ~emphase#!\highLight[LightPink]{!@return n*fact(n-1)~emphase#!}!@ % \end{Piton} % \end{Verbatim} % % \begin{Piton} % def fact(n): % if n==0: % return 1 % else: % !\highLight[LightPink]{!return n*fact(n-1)!}! % \end{Piton} % % % % \bigskip % \emph{Caution} : The mechanism ``escape'' is not active in the strings nor in % the Python comments (however, it's possible to have a whole Python comment % composed in LaTeX by beginning it with |#>|; such comments are merely called % ``LaTeX comments'' in this document). % % % \subsubsection{The mechanism ``escape-math''} % % The mechanism ``escape-math'' is very similar to the mechanism ``escape'' % since the only difference is that the elements sent to LaTeX are composed in % the math mode of LaTeX. % % This mechanism is activated with the keys \Definition{begin-escape-math} and % \Definition{end-escape-math} (\emph{which are available only in the preamble of the % document}). % % Despite the technical similarity, the use of the the mechanism % ``escape-math'' is in fact rather different from that of the mechanism % ``escape''. Indeed, since the elements are composed in a mathematical mode % of LaTeX, they are, in particular, composed within a TeX group and, therefore, % they can't be used to change the formatting of other lexical units. % % In the languages where the character \verb|$| does not play a important role, % it's possible to activate that mechanism ``escape-math'' with the character % \verb|$|: % \begin{Verbatim} % \PitonOptions{~emphase#begin-escape-math=$,end-escape-math=$@} % \end{Verbatim} % Remark that the character \verb|$| must \emph{not} be protected by a backslash. % % \bigskip % However, it's probably more prudent to use |\(| et |\)|, which are delimiters % of the mathematical mode provided by LaTeX. % \begin{Verbatim} % \PitonOptions{~emphase#begin-escape-math=\(,end-escape-math=\)@} % \end{Verbatim} % % \bigskip % Here is an example of utilisation. % % \medskip % \begin{Verbatim} % \begin{Piton}[line-numbers] % def arctan(x,n=10): % if ~emphase#\(x < 0\)@ : % return ~emphase#\(-\arctan(-x)\)@ % elif ~emphase#\(x > 1\)@ : % return ~emphase#\(\pi/2 - \arctan(1/x)\)@ % else: % s = ~emphase#\(0\)@ % for ~emphase#\(k\)@ in range(~emphase#\(n\)@): s += ~emphase#\(\smash{\frac{(-1)^k}{2k+1} x^{2k+1}}\)@ % return s % \end{Piton} % \end{Verbatim} % % % \bigskip % % \begin{Piton}[line-numbers] % def arctan(x,n=10): % if \(x < 0\) : % return \(-\arctan(-x)\) % elif \(x > 1\) : % return \(\pi/2 - \arctan(1/x)\) % else: % s = \(0\) % for \(k\) in range(\(n\)): s += \(\smash{\frac{(-1)^k}{2k+1} x^{2k+1}}\) % return s % \end{Piton} % % % \subsection{Behaviour in the class Beamer} % % \label{beamer} % \index{Beamer@\cls{Beamer} (class)} % % \emph{First remark}\par\nobreak % Since the environment |{Piton}| catches its body with a verbatim mode, it's % necessary to use the environments |{Piton}| within environments |{frame}| of % Beamer protected by the key |fragile|, i.e. beginning with % |\begin{frame}[fragile]|.\footnote{Remind that for an environment % \texttt{\{frame\}} of Beamer using the key |fragile|, the instruction % \texttt{\textbackslash end\{frame\}} must be alone on a single line (except % for any leading whitespace).} % % % \bigskip % When the package \pkg{piton} is used within the class % \cls{beamer}\footnote{The extension \pkg{piton} detects the class \cls{beamer} % and the package \pkg{beamerarticle} if it is loaded previously % but, if needed, it's also possible to activate that mechanism with the key % |beamer| provided by \pkg{piton} at load-time: |\textbackslash % usepackage[beamer]\{piton\}|}, the behaviour of \pkg{piton} is slightly % modified, as described now. % % \subsubsection{\{Piton\} et \textbackslash PitonInputFile are % ``overlay-aware''} % % When \pkg{piton} is used in the class \cls{beamer}, the environment |{Piton}| % and the command |\PitonInputFile| accept the optional argument |<...>| of % Beamer for the overlays which are involved. % % For example, it's possible to write: % % \begin{Verbatim} % \begin{Piton}~emphase#<2-5>@ % ... % \end{Piton} % \end{Verbatim} % % and % % \begin{Verbatim} % \PitonInputFile~emphase#<2-5>@{my_file.py} % \end{Verbatim} % % \subsubsection{Commands of Beamer allowed in \{Piton\} and \textbackslash PitonInputFile} % % \index{detected-beamer-commands} % % When \pkg{piton} is used in the class \cls{beamer} , the following commands of % \cls{beamer} (classified upon their number of arguments) are automatically % detected in the environments |{Piton}| (and in the listings processed by % |\PitonInputFile|): % \begin{itemize} % \item no mandatory argument : |\pause|\footnote{One should remark that it's % also possible to use the command \texttt{\textbackslash pause} in a ``LaTeX % comment'', that is to say by writing \texttt{\#> \textbackslash pause}. By % this way, if the Python code is copied, it's still executable by Python}. ; % \item one mandatory argument : |\action|, |\alert|, |\invisible|, |\only|, % |\uncover| and |\visible| ; \newline % % It's possible to add new commands to that list with the key % \Definition{detected-beamer-commands} (the names of the commands must % \emph{not} be preceded by a backslash). % \item two mandatory arguments : |\alt| ; % \item three mandatory arguments : |\temporal|. % \end{itemize} % \medskip % These commands must be used preceded and following by a space. In the % mandatory arguments of these commands, the braces must be balanced. However, % the braces included in short strings\footnote{The short strings of Python are % the strings delimited by characters \texttt{'} or the characters \texttt{"} % and not \texttt{'''} nor \texttt{"""}. In Python, the short strings can't % extend on several lines.} of Python are not considered. % % \medskip % Regarding the functions |\alt| and |\temporal| there should be no carriage % returns in the mandatory arguments of these functions. % % \medskip % Here is a complete example of file: % % \begin{Verbatim}[formatcom = \small\color{gray}] % \documentclass{beamer} % \usepackage{piton} % \begin{document} % \begin{frame}[fragile] % \begin{Piton} % def string_of_list(l): % """Convert a list of numbers in string""" % ~emphase# \only<2->{s = "{" + str(l[0])}@ % ~emphase# \only<3->{for x in l[1:]: s = s + "," + str(x)}@ % ~emphase# \only<4->{s = s + "}"}@ % return s % \end{Piton} % \end{frame} % \end{document} % \end{Verbatim} % % In the previous example, the braces in the Python strings |"{"| and |"}"| are % correctly interpreted (without any escape character). % % % % % \bigskip % \subsubsection{Environments of Beamer allowed in \{Piton\} and \textbackslash PitonInputFile} % % When \pkg{piton} is used in the class \pkg{beamer}, the following environments % of Beamer are directly detected in the environments |{Piton}| (and in the % listings processed by |\PitonInputFile|): |{actionenv}|, |{alertenv}|, % |{invisibleenv}|, |{onlyenv}|, |{uncoverenv}| and |{visibleenv}|. % % \smallskip % \index{detected-beamer-environments} % It's possible to add new environments to that list with the key % \Definition{detected-beamer-environments}. % % \smallskip % % However, there is a restriction: these environments must contain only \emph{whole % lines of Python code} in their body. The instructions |\begin{...}| and % |\end{...}| must be alone on their lines. % %\medskip % Here is an example: % % \begin{Verbatim}[formatcom = \small\color{gray}] % \documentclass{beamer} % \usepackage{piton} % \begin{document} % \begin{frame}[fragile] % \begin{Piton} % def square(x): % """Compure the square of its argument""" % ~emphase#\begin{uncoverenv}<2>@ % return x*x % ~emphase#\end{uncoverenv}@ % \end{Piton} % \end{frame} % \end{document} % \end{Verbatim} % % % \vspace{1cm} % \textbf{Remark concerning the command \textbackslash alert and the environment % \{alertenv\} of Beamer}\par\nobreak % % \smallskip % Beamer provides an easy way to change the color used by the environment % |{alertenv}| (and by the command |\alert| which relies upon it) to highlight % its argument. Here is an example: % % \begin{Verbatim} % \setbeamercolor{~emphase#alerted text@}{fg=blue} % \end{Verbatim} % % However, when used inside an environment |{Piton}|, such tuning will probably % not be the best choice because \pkg{piton} will, by design, change (most of % the time) the color the different elements of text. One may prefer an environment % |{alertenv}| that will change the background color for the elements to be % highlighted. % % \smallskip % Here is a code that will do that job and add a yellow background. That code % uses the command |\@highLight| of \pkg{lua-ul} (that extension requires also % the package \pkg{luacolor}). % % \begingroup % \fvset{commandchars=\~\#\+,formatcom=\color{gray}} % \begin{Verbatim} % \setbeamercolor{alerted text}{bg=yellow!50} % \makeatletter % \AddToHook{env/Piton/begin} % {\renewenvironment<>{alertenv}{\only~#1{~emphase#\@highLight+[alerted text.bg]}}{}} % \makeatother % \end{Verbatim} % \endgroup % % That code redefines locally the environment |{alertenv}| within the % environments |{Piton}| (we recall that the command |\alert| relies upon that % environment |{alertenv}|). % % % \subsection{Footnotes in the environments of piton} % % \index{footnote@\pkg{footnote} (extension)} % \index{footnote (key)} % \index{footnotehyper@\pkg{footnotehyper} (extension)} % \index{footnotehyper (key)} % % \label{footnote} % If you want to put footnotes in an environment |{Piton}| or % (or, more unlikely, in a listing produced by |\PitonInputFile|), you can use a % pair |\footnotemark|--|\footnotetext|. % % \smallskip % However, it's also possible to extract the footnotes with the help of the % package \pkg{footnote} or the package \pkg{footnotehyper}. % % \smallskip % If \pkg{piton} is loaded with the option \Definition{footnote} (with % |\usepackage[footnote]{piton}| or with |\PassOptionsToPackage|), the % package \pkg{footnote} is loaded (if it is not yet loaded) and it is used to % extract the footnotes. % % \smallskip % If \pkg{piton} is loaded with the option \Definition{footnotehyper}, the % package \pkg{footnotehyper} is loaded (if it is not yet loaded) ant it is used % to extract footnotes. % % \smallskip % Caution: The packages \pkg{footnote} and \pkg{footnotehyper} are incompatible. % The package \pkg{footnotehyper} is the successor of the package \pkg{footnote} % and should be used preferently. The package \pkg{footnote} has some drawbacks, % in particular: it must be loaded after the package \pkg{xcolor} and it is not % perfectly compatible with \pkg{hyperref}. % % % \medskip % \textbf{Important remark} : If you use Beamer, you should know taht Beamer has % its own system to extract the footnotes. Therefore, \pkg{piton} must be loaded % in that class without the option |footnote| nor the option |footnotehyper|. % % % \bigskip % By default, in an environment |{Piton}|, a command |\footnote| may appear only % within a ``LaTeX comment''. But it's also possible to add the command % |\footnote| to the list of the ``\emph{detected-commands}'' % (cf.~part~\ref{detected-commands}, p.~\pageref{detected-commands}). % \medskip % In this document, the package \pkg{piton} has been loaded with the % option |footnotehyper| dans we added the command |\footnote| to the list of % the ``\emph{detected-commands}'' with the following instruction in the % preamble of the LaTeX document. % % \qquad \verb|\PitonOptions{detected-commands = footnote}| % % % \begingroup % \fvset{commandchars=\~\&\@,formatcom=\small\color{gray}} % \begin{Verbatim} % \PitonOptions{background-color=gray!15} % \begin{Piton} % def arctan(x,n=10): % if x < 0: % return -arctan(-x)~emphase&\footnote{First recursive call.}]@ % elif x > 1: % return pi/2 - arctan(1/x)~emphase&\footnote{Second recursive call.}@ % else: % return sum( (-1)**k/(2*k+1)*x**(2*k+1) for k in range(n) ) % \end{Piton} % \end{Verbatim} % \endgroup % % \begingroup % \PitonOptions{background-color=gray!15} % \begin{Piton} % def arctan(x,n=10): % if x < 0: % return -arctan(-x)\footnote{First recursive call.} % elif x > 1: % return pi/2 - arctan(1/x)\footnote{Second recursive call.} % else: % return sum( (-1)**k/(2*k+1)*x**(2*k+1) for k in range(n) ) % \end{Piton} % \endgroup % % % \vspace{1cm} % % If an environment |{Piton}| is used in an environment |{minipage}| of LaTeX, % the notes are composed, of course, at the foot of the environment % |{minipage}|. Recall that such |{minipage}| can't be broken by a page break. % % % \begingroup % \fvset{commandchars=\~\&\@,formatcom=\small\color{gray}} % \begin{Verbatim} % \PitonOptions{background-color=gray!15} % \emphase\begin{minipage}{\linewidth} % \begin{Piton} % def arctan(x,n=10): % if x < 0: % return -arctan(-x)~emphase&\footnote{First recursive call.}@ % elif x > 1: % return pi/2 - arctan(1/x)~emphase&\footnote{Second recursive call.}@ % else: % return sum( (-1)**k/(2*k+1)*x**(2*k+1) for k in range(n) ) % \end{Piton} % \end{minipage} % \end{Verbatim} % \endgroup % % \begingroup % \PitonOptions{background-color=gray!15} % \begin{minipage}{\linewidth} % \begin{Piton} % def arctan(x,n=10): % if x < 0: % return -arctan(-x)\footnote{First recursive call.} % elif x > 1: % return pi/2 - arctan(1/x)\footnote{Second recursive call.} % else: % return sum( (-1)**k/(2*k+1)*x**(2*k+1) for k in range(n) ) % \end{Piton} % \end{minipage} % \endgroup % % % \subsection{Tabulations} % % \index{tabulations} % \index{tab-size} % % \smallskip % Even though it's probably recommended to indent the informatics listings with % spaces and not tabulations\footnote{For the language Python, see the note % % PEP~8}, \pkg{piton} accepts the characters of tabulation (that is to say the % characters U+0009) at the beginning of the lines. Each character U+0009 is % replaced by $n$~spaces. The initial value of $n$ is $4$ but it's possible to % change it with the key \Definition{tab-size} of |\PitonOptions|. % % \smallskip % There exists also a key \Definition{tabs-auto-gobble} which computes the % minimal value $n$ of the number of consecutive characters U+0009 beginning % each (non empty) line of the environment |{Piton}| and applies |gobble| with % that value of~$n$ (before replacement of the tabulations by spaces, of % course). Hence, that key is similar to the key |auto-gobble| but acts on % U+0009 instead of U+0020 (spaces). % % The key |env-gobble| is not compatible with the tabulations. % % % \bigskip % \section{API for the developpers} % % \label{API} % % The L3 variable \DefinitionCommand{l_piton_language_str} contains the name of % the current language of \pkg{piton} (in lower case). % % \bigskip % % The extension \pkg{piton} provides a Lua function % \Definition{piton.get_last_code} without argument which returns the code in % the latest environment of \pkg{piton}. % \begin{itemize} % \item The carriage returns (which are present in the initial environment) % appears as characters |\r| (i.e. U+000D). % % \item The code returned by |piton.get_last_code()| takes into account the % potential application of a key |gobble|, |auto-gobble| or |env-gobble| % (cf.~p.~\pageref{gobble}). % % \item The extra formatting elements added in the code are deleted in the code % returned by |piton.get_last_code()|. That concerns the LaTeX commands declared % by the key |detected-commands| (cf. part~\ref{detected-commands}) and the % elements inserted by the mechanism ``|escape|'' (cf. part~\ref{escape}). % % \item |piton.get_last_code| is a Lua function and not a Lua string: the % treatments outlined above are executed when the function is called. Therefore, % it might be judicious to store the value returned by |piton.get_last_code()| % in a variable of Lua if it will be used several times. % \end{itemize} % % \medskip % For an example of use, see the part concerning |pyluatex|, part~\ref{pyluatex}, % p.~\pageref{pyluatex}. % % % \section{Examples} % % \subsection{Line numbering} % % \label{example-numbering} % \index{numbers of the lines de code|emph} % % We remind that it's possible to have an automatic numbering of the lines in % the informatic listings by using the key |line-numbers| (used without value). % % By default, the numbers of the lines are composed by \pkg{piton} in an % overlapping position on the left (by using internally the command |\llap| of LaTeX). % % In order to avoid that overlapping, it's possible to use the option |left-margin=auto| % which will insert automatically a margin adapted to the numbers of lines that % will be written (that margin is larger when the numbers are greater than~10). % % % \begingroup % \fvset{commandchars=\~\&\@,formatcom=\small\color{gray}} % \begin{Verbatim} % ~emphase&\PitonOptions{background-color=gray!15, left-margin = auto, line-numbers}@ % \begin{Piton} % def arctan(x,n=10): % if x < 0: % return -arctan(-x) #> (recursive call) % elif x > 1: % return pi/2 - arctan(1/x) #> (other recursive call) % else: % return sum( (-1)**k/(2*k+1)*x**(2*k+1) for k in range(n) ) % \end{Piton} % \end{Verbatim} % \endgroup % % % % \begingroup % \PitonOptions{background-color=gray!15,left-margin = auto, line-numbers} % \begin{Piton} % def arctan(x,n=10): % if x < 0: % return -arctan(-x) #> (recursive call) % elif x > 1: % return pi/2 - arctan(1/x) #> (other recursive call) % else: % return sum( (-1)**k/(2*k+1)*x**(2*k+1) for k in range(n) ) % \end{Piton} % \endgroup % % % % \bigskip % \subsection{Formatting of the LaTeX comments} % % \label{example-comments} % % It's possible to modify the style |Comment.LaTeX| (with |\SetPitonStyle|) in % order to display the LaTeX comments (which begin with |#>|) aligned on the % right margin. % % % \begingroup % \fvset{commandchars=\~\&\@,formatcom=\small\color{gray}} % \begin{Verbatim} % \PitonOptions{background-color=gray!15} % ~emphase&\SetPitonStyle{Comment.LaTeX = \hfill \normalfont\color{gray}}@ % \begin{Piton} % def arctan(x,n=10): % if x < 0: % return -arctan(-x) #> recursive call % elif x > 1: % return pi/2 - arctan(1/x) #> other recursive call % else: % return sum( (-1)**k/(2*k+1)*x**(2*k+1) for k in range(n) ) % \end{Piton} % \end{Verbatim} % \endgroup % % \begingroup % \PitonOptions{background-color=gray!15} % \SetPitonStyle{Comment.LaTeX = \hfill \normalfont\color{gray}} % \begin{Piton} % def arctan(x,n=10): % if x < 0: % return -arctan(-x) #> recursive call % elif x > 1: % return pi/2 - arctan(1/x) #> another recursive call % else: % return sum( (-1)**k/(2*k+1)*x**(2*k+1) for k in range(n) ) % \end{Piton} % \endgroup % % % \vspace{1cm} % It's also possible to display these LaTeX comments in a kind of second column % by limiting the width of the Python code with the key |width|. In the % following example, we use the key |width| with the special value~|min|. % Several compilations are required. % % \begingroup % \fvset{commandchars=\~\&\@,formatcom=\small\color{gray}} % \begin{Verbatim} % \PitonOptions{background-color=gray!15, width=min} % ~emphase&\NewDocumentCommand{\MyLaTeXCommand}{m}{\hfill \normalfont\itshape\rlap{\quad #1}}@ % ~emphase&\SetPitonStyle{Comment.LaTeX = \MyLaTeXCommand}@ % \begin{Piton} % def arctan(x,n=10): % if x < 0: % return -arctan(-x) #> recursive call % elif x > 1: % return pi/2 - arctan(1/x) #> another recursive call % else: % s = 0 % for k in range(n): % s += (-1)**k/(2*k+1)*x**(2*k+1) % return s % \end{Piton} % \end{Verbatim} % \endgroup % % % % \begingroup % \PitonOptions{background-color=gray!15, width=min} % \NewDocumentCommand{\MyLaTeXCommand}{m}{\hfill \normalfont\itshape\rlap{\quad #1}} % \SetPitonStyle{Comment.LaTeX = \MyLaTeXCommand} % \begin{Piton} % def arctan(x,n=10): % if x < 0: % return -arctan(-x) #> recursive call % elif x > 1: % return pi/2 - arctan(1/x) #> another recursive call % else: % s = 0 % for k in range(n): % s += (-1)**k/(2*k+1)*x**(2*k+1) % return s % \end{Piton} % \endgroup % % % % % % \bigskip % % \subsection{An example of tuning of the styles} % % The graphical styles have been presented in the section \ref{styles}, % p.~\pageref{styles}. % % \smallskip % We present now an example of tuning of these styles adapted to the documents % in black and white. % % That tuning uses the command |\highLight| of \pkg{lua-ul} (that package % requires itself the package \pkg{luacolor}). % % \begin{Verbatim} % \SetPitonStyle % { % Number = , % String = \itshape , % String.Doc = \color{gray} \slshape , % Operator = , % Operator.Word = \bfseries , % Name.Builtin = , % Name.Function = \bfseries \highLight[gray!20] , % Comment = \color{gray} , % Comment.LaTeX = \normalfont \color{gray}, % Keyword = \bfseries , % Name.Namespace = , % Name.Class = , % Name.Type = , % InitialValues = \color{gray} % } % \end{Verbatim} % % In that tuning, many values given to the keys are empty: that means that the % corresponding style won't insert any formatting instruction (the element will % be composed in the standard color, usually in black, etc.). Nevertheless, % those entries are mandatory because the initial value of those keys in % \pkg{piton} is \emph{not} empty. % % \begingroup % \PitonOptions{splittable} % % \SetPitonStyle % { % Number = , % String = \itshape , % String.Doc = \color{gray} \slshape , % Operator.Word = \bfseries , % Operator = , % Name.Builtin = , % Name.Function = \bfseries \highLight[gray!20] , % Comment = \color{gray} , % Comment.LaTeX = \normalfont \color{gray} , % Keyword = \bfseries , % Name.Namespace = , % Name.Class = , % Name.Type = , % InitialValues = \color{gray} % } % % % \bigskip % % \begin{Piton} % from math import pi % % def arctan(x,n=10): % """Compute the mathematical value of arctan(x) % % n is the number of terms in the sum % """ % if x < 0: % return -arctan(-x) # recursive call % elif x > 1: % return pi/2 - arctan(1/x) % #> (we have used that $\arctan(x)+\arctan(1/x)=\pi/2$ for $x>0$) % else: % s = 0 % for k in range(n): % s += (-1)**k/(2*k+1)*x**(2*k+1) % return s % \end{Piton} % % \endgroup % % \subsection{Use with pyluatex} % % \index{pyluatex@{\pkg{pyluatex}} (extension)} % \label{pyluatex} % % The package \pkg{pyluatex} is an extension which allows the execution of some % Python code from |lualatex| (provided that Python is installed on the machine % and that the compilation is done with |lualatex| and |--shell-escape|). % % Here is, for example, an environment |{PitonExecute}| which formats a Python % listing (with \pkg{piton}) but also displays the output of the execution of the % code with Python. % % \medskip % \begin{Verbatim} % \NewPitonEnvironment{~emphase#PitonExecute@}{!O{}} % {\PitonOptions{~#1}} % {\begin{center} % \directlua{pyluatex.execute(piton.get_last_code(), false, true, false, true)}% % \end{center} % \ignorespacesafterend} % \end{Verbatim} % % \medskip % We have used the Lua function |piton.get_last_code| provided in the API of % \pkg{piton} : cf.~part~\ref{API}, p.~\pageref{API}. % % \medskip % This environment |{PitonExecute}| takes in as optional argument (between % square brackets) the options of the command |\PitonOptions|. % % % % \clearpage % \section{The styles for the different computer languages} % % \label{Semantic} % % % \subsection{The language Python} % % In \pkg{piton}, the default language is Python. If necessary, it's possible to % come back to the language Python with |\PitonOptions{language=Python}|. % % \bigskip % % The initial settings % done by \pkg{piton} in |piton.sty| are inspired by the style \pkg{manni} de % Pygments, as applied by Pygments to the language Python.\footnote{See: % \url{https://pygments.org/styles/}. Remark that, by default, Pygments provides % for its style \pkg{manni} a colored background whose color is the HTML color % \texttt{\#F0F3F3}. It's possible to have the same color in \texttt{\{Piton\}} % with the instruction \texttt{\textbackslash PitonOptions\{background-color = % [HTML]\{F0F3F3\}\}}.} % % \vspace{1cm} % % \begin{center} % \begin{tabularx}{\textwidth}{@{}>{\ttfamily}l>{\raggedright\arraybackslash}X@{}} % \toprule % \normalfont Style & Use \\ % \midrule % Number & the numbers \\ % String.Short & the short strings (entre \texttt{'} ou \texttt{"}) \\ % String.Long & the long strings (entre \texttt{'''} ou \texttt{"""}) excepted % the doc-strings (governed by |String.Doc|)\\ % String & that key fixes both |String.Short| et |String.Long| \\ % String.Doc & the doc-strings (only with |"""| following PEP~257) \\ % String.Interpol & the syntactic elements of the fields of the f-strings % (that is to say the characters \texttt{\{} et \texttt{\}}); that style % inherits for the styles |String.Short| and |String.Long| (according the kind % of string where the interpolation appears) \\ % Interpol.Inside & the content of the interpolations in the f-strings (that % is to say the elements between \texttt{\{} and~\texttt{\}}); if the final % user has not set that key, those elements will be formatted by \pkg{piton} % as done for any Python code. \\ % Operator & the following operators: \texttt{!= == << >> - \~{} + / * \% = < > % \& .} \verb+|+ \verb|@| \\ % Operator.Word & the following operators: |in|, |is|, |and|, |or| et |not| \\ % Name.Builtin & almost all the functions predefined by Python \\ % Name.Decorator & the decorators (instructions beginning by \verb|@|) \\ % Name.Namespace & the name of the modules \\ % Name.Class & the name of the Python classes defined by the user \emph{at their % point of definition} (with the keyword |class|) \\ % Name.Function & the name of the Python functions defined by the user \emph{at their % point of definition} (with the keyword |def|) \\ % UserFunction & the name of the Python functions previously defined by the user % (the initial value of that parameter is % {\ttfamily \textbackslash PitonStyle\{Identifier\}} and, % therefore, the names of that functions are formatted like the % identifiers). \\ % Exception & les exceptions prédéfinies (ex.: \texttt{SyntaxError}) \\ % InitialValues & the initial values (and the preceding symbol |=|) of the % optional arguments in the definitions of functions; if the final % user has not set that key, those elements will be formatted by \pkg{piton} % as done for any Python code. \\ % Comment & the comments beginning with \texttt{\#} \\ % Comment.LaTeX & the comments beginning with \texttt{\#>}, which are composed by % \pkg{piton} as LaTeX code (merely named ``LaTeX comments'' in this document) \\ % Keyword.Constant & |True|, |False| et |None| \\ % Keyword & the following keywords: % \ttfamily assert, break, case, continue, del, % elif, else, except, exec, finally, for, from, % global, if, import, in, lambda, non local, % pass, raise, return, try, while, % with, yield et yield from.\\ % Identifier & the identifiers. \\ % \bottomrule % \end{tabularx} % \end{center} % % % \newpage % % \subsection{The language OCaml} % % It's possible to switch to the language |OCaml| with the key |language|: % |language = OCaml|. % % % \bigskip % % % \begin{center} % \begin{tabularx}{0.9\textwidth}{@{}>{\ttfamily}l>{\raggedright\arraybackslash}X@{}} % \toprule % \normalfont Style & Use \\ % \midrule % Number & the numbers \\ % String.Short & the characters (between \texttt{'}) \\ % String.Long & the strings, between |"| but also the \emph{quoted-strings} \\ % String & that key fixes both |String.Short| and |String.Long| \\ % Operator & les opérateurs, en particulier |+|, |-|, |/|, |*|, |@|, |!=|, |==|, |&&| \\ % Operator.Word & les opérateurs suivants : |asr|, |land|, |lor|, |lsl|, |lxor|, |mod| et |or| \\ % Name.Builtin & les fonctions |not|, |incr|, |decr|, |fst| et |snd| \\ % Name.Type & the name of a type of OCaml \\ % Name.Field & the name of a field of a module \\ % Name.Constructor & the name of the constructors of types (which begins by a capital) \\ % Name.Module & the name of the modules \\ % Name.Function & the name of the Python functions defined by the user \emph{at their % point of definition} (with the keyword |let|) \\ % UserFunction & the name of the Python functions previously defined by the user % (the initial value of that parameter is % {\ttfamily \textbackslash PitonStyle\{Identifier\}} and, % therefore, the names of that functions are formatted like the identifiers). \\ % Exception & the predefined exceptions (eg : |End_of_File|) \\ % TypeParameter & the parameters of the types \\ % Comment & the comments, between |(*| et |*)|; these comments may be nested \\ % Keyword.Constant & |true| et |false| \\ % Keyword & the following keywords: |assert|, |as|, |done|, |downto|, |do|, % |else|, |exception|, |for|, |function| , |fun|, |if|, |lazy|, |match|, % |mutable|, |new|, |of|, |private|, |raise|, |then|, |to|, |try| , |virtual|, % |when|, |while| and |with| \\ % Keyword.Governing & the following keywords: |and|, |begin|, |class|, |constraint|, % |end|, |external|, |functor|, |include|, |inherit|, |initializer|, % |in|, |let|, |method|, |module|, |object|, |open|, |rec|, |sig|, % |struct|, |type| and |val|. \\ % Identifier & the identifiers. \\ % \bottomrule % \end{tabularx} % \end{center} % % \newpage % % \subsection[The language C (and C++)]{The language C (and \CC)} % % % It's possible to switch to the language |C| with the key |language|: |language = C|. % % \bigskip % % \begin{center} % \begin{tabularx}{0.9\textwidth}{@{}>{\ttfamily}l>{\raggedright\arraybackslash}X@{}} % \toprule % \normalfont Style & Use \\ % \midrule % Number & the numbers \\ % String.Long & the strings (between \texttt{"}) \\ % String.Interpol & the elements \texttt{\%d}, \texttt{\%i}, \texttt{\%f}, % \texttt{\%c}, etc. in the strings; that style inherits from the style |String.Long| \\ % Operator & the following operators : % \texttt{!= == << >> - \~{} + / * \% = < > \& .} \verb+|+ \verb|@| \\ % Name.Type & the following predefined types: % |bool|, |char|, |char16_t|, |char32_t|, |double|, |float|, |int|, |int8_t|, % |int16_t|, |int32_t|, |int64_t|, |long|, |short|, |signed|, |unsigned|, % |void| et |wchar_t| \\ % Name.Builtin & the following predefined functions: |printf|, |scanf|, % |malloc|, |sizeof| and |alignof| \\ % Name.Class & le nom des classes au moment de leur définition, c'est-à-dire % après le mot-clé \verb|class| \\ % Name.Function & the name of the Python functions defined by the user \emph{at their % point of definition} (with the keyword |let|) \\ % UserFunction & the name of the Python functions previously defined by the user % (the initial value of that parameter is % {\ttfamily \textbackslash PitonStyle\{Identifier\}} and, % therefore, the names of that functions are formatted like the % identifiers). \\ % Preproc & the instructions of the preprocessor (beginning par |#|) \\ % Comment & the comments (beginning by \texttt{//} or between |/*| and |*/|) \\ % Comment.LaTeX & the comments beginning by \texttt{//>} which are composed by % \pkg{piton} as LaTeX code (merely named ``LaTeX comments'' in this document) \\ % Keyword.Constant & |default|, |false|, |NULL|, |nullptr| and |true| \\ % Keyword & the following keywords: % |alignas|, |asm|, |auto|, |break|, |case|, |catch|, |class|, % |constexpr|, |const|, |continue|, |decltype|, |do|, |else|, |enum|, % |extern|, |for|, |goto|, |if|, |nexcept|, |private|, |public|, |register|, % |restricted|, |try|, |return|, |static|, |static_assert|, |struct|, |switch|, % |thread_local|, |throw|, |typedef|, |union|, |using|, |virtual|, |volatile| % and |while| \\ % Identifier & the identifiers. \\ % \bottomrule % \end{tabularx} % \end{center} % % \newpage % % \subsection{The language SQL} % % % It's possible to switch to the language |SQL| with the key |language|: |language = SQL|. % % \bigskip % % \begin{center} % \begin{tabularx}{0.9\textwidth}{@{}>{\ttfamily}l>{\raggedright\arraybackslash}X@{}} % \toprule % \normalfont Style & Use \\ % \midrule % Number & the numbers \\ % String.Long & the strings (between \texttt{'} and not \texttt{"} because the % elements between \texttt{"} are names of fields and formatted with |Name.Field|) \\ % Operator & the following operators : \texttt{= != <> >= > < <= * + / } \\ % Name.Table & the names of the tables \\ % Name.Field & the names of the fields of the tables \\ % Name.Builtin & the following built-in functions (their names are \emph{not} case-sensitive): % |avg|, |count|, |char_length|, |concat|, |curdate|, |current_date|, % |date_format|, |day|, |lower|, |ltrim|, |max|, |min|, |month|, |now|, % |rank|, |round|, |rtrim|, |substring|, |sum|, |upper| and |year|. \\ % Comment & the comments (beginning by \texttt{--} or between |/*| and |*/|) \\ % Comment.LaTeX & the comments beginning by \texttt{-->} which are composed by % \pkg{piton} as LaTeX code (merely named ``LaTeX comments'' in this document) \\ % Keyword & the following keywords (their names are \emph{not} case-sensitive): % |abort|, |action|, |add|, |after|, |all|, |alter|, |always|, |analyze|, % |and|, |as|, |asc|, |attach|, |autoincrement|, |before|, |begin|, |between|, % |by|, |cascade|, |case|, |cast|, |check|, |collate|, |column|, |commit|, % |conflict|, |constraint|, |create|, |cross|, |current|, |current_date|, % |current_time|, |current_timestamp|, |database|, |default|, |deferrable|, % |deferred|, |delete|, |desc|, |detach|, |distinct|, |do|, |drop|, |each|, % |else|, |end|, |escape|, |except|, |exclude|, |exclusive|, |exists|, % |explain|, |fail|, |filter|, |first|, |following|, |for|, |foreign|, |from|, % |full|, |generated|, |glob|, |group|, |groups|, |having|, |if|, |ignore|, % |immediate|, |in|, |index|, |indexed|, |initially|, |inner|, |insert|, % |instead|, |intersect|, |into|, |is|, |isnull|, |join|, |key|, |last|, % |left|, |like|, |limit|, |match|, |materialized|, |natural|, |no|, |not|, % |nothing|, |notnull|, |null|, |nulls|, |of|, |offset|, |on|, |or|, |order|, % |others|, |outer|, |over|, |partition|, |plan|, |pragma|, |preceding|, % |primary|, |query|, |raise|, |range|, |recursive|, |references|, |regexp|, % |reindex|, |release|, |rename|, |replace|, |restrict|, |returning|, |right|, % |rollback|, |row|, |rows|, |savepoint|, |select|, |set|, |table|, |temp|, % |temporary|, |then|, |ties|, |to|, |transaction|, |trigger|, |unbounded|, % |union|, |unique|, |update|, |using|, |vacuum|, |values|, |view|, |virtual|, % |when|, |where|, |window|, |with|, |without| \\ % \bottomrule % \end{tabularx} % \end{center} % % % \bigskip % It's possible to automatically capitalize the keywords by modifying locally % for the language SQL the style |Keywords|. % \begin{Verbatim} % \SetPitonStyle~emphase#[SQL]@{Keywords = \bfseries \MakeUppercase} % \end{Verbatim} % % \newpage % \subsection{The languages defined by \textbackslash NewPitonLanguage} % % \vspace{1cm} % The command |\NewPitonLanguage|, which defines new informatic languages with the % syntax of the extension \pkg{listings}, has been described p.~\pageref{NewPitonLanguage}. % % All the languages defined by the command |\NewPitonLanguage| use the same styles. % \vspace{1cm} % % \begin{center} % \begin{tabularx}{0.9\textwidth}{@{}>{\ttfamily}l>{\raggedright\arraybackslash}X@{}} % \toprule % \normalfont Style & Use \\ % \midrule % Number & the numbers \\ % String.Long & the strings defined in |\NewPitonLanguage| by the key |morestring| \\ % Comment & the comments defined in |\NewPitonLanguage| by the key |morecomment| \\ % Comment.LaTeX & the comments which are composed by \pkg{piton} as LaTeX code (merely named ``LaTeX comments'' in this document) \\ % Keyword & the keywords defined in |\NewPitonLanguage| by the keys |morekeywords| % and |moretexcs| (and also the key |sensitive| which specifies whether % the keywords are case-sensitive or not) \\ % Directive & the directives defined in |\NewPitonLanguage| by the key % |moredirectives| \\ % Tag & the ``tags'' defined by the key |tag| (the lexical units detected within % the tag will also be formatted with their own style) \\ % Identifier & the identifiers. \\ % \bottomrule % \end{tabularx} % \end{center} % % % % % \subsection{The language ``minimal''} % % \label{minimal} % % It's possible to switch to the language ``|minimal|'' with the key |language|: % |language = minimal|. % % \bigskip % % \begin{center} % \begin{tabularx}{0.9\textwidth}{@{}>{\ttfamily}l>{\raggedright\arraybackslash}X@{}} % \toprule % \normalfont Style & Usage \\ % \midrule % Number & the numbers \\ % String & the strings (between \texttt{"}) \\ % Comment & the comments (which begin with |#|) \\ % Comment.LaTeX & the comments beginning with \texttt{\#>}, which are composed by % \pkg{piton} as LaTeX code (merely named ``LaTeX comments'' in this document) % \\ % Identifier & the identifiers. \\ % \bottomrule % \end{tabularx} % \end{center} % % \bigskip % That language is provided for the final user who might wish to add keywords in % that language (with the command |\SetPitonIdentifier|: cf. \ref{SetPitonIdentifier}, % p.~\pageref{SetPitonIdentifier}) in order to create, for example, a language % for pseudo-code. % % \vspace{1cm} % % \subsection{The language ``verbatim''} % % \label{verbatim} % % \colorbox{yellow!50}{\textbf{New 4.1}} % % It's possible to switch to the language ``|verbatim|'' with the key |language|: % |language = verbatim|. % % \bigskip % % \begin{center} % \begin{tabularx}{0.9\textwidth}{@{}>{\ttfamily}l>{\raggedright\arraybackslash}X@{}} % \toprule % \normalfont Style & Usage \\ % \midrule % None... & \\ % \bottomrule % \end{tabularx} % \end{center} % % The language |verbatim| doen't provide any style and, thus, does not do any % syntactic formating. However, it's possible to use the mechanism % |detected-commands| (cf. part~\ref{detected-commands}, % p.~\pageref{detected-commands}) and the detection of the commands and % environments of Beamer. % % % \newpage % % \section{Implementation} % % \medskip % The development of the extension \pkg{piton} is done on the following GitHub % depot: % % \verb|https://github.com/fpantigny/piton| % % \subsection{Introduction} % % The main job of the package \pkg{piton} is to take in as input a Python % listing and to send back to LaTeX as output that code \emph{with interlaced LaTeX % instructions of formatting}. % % In fact, all that job is done by a \textsc{lpeg} called |python|. That % \textsc{lpeg}, when matched against the string of a Python listing, % returns as capture a Lua table containing data to send to LaTeX. % The only thing to do after will be to apply |tex.tprint| to each element of % that table.\footnote{Recall that |tex.tprint| takes in as argument a Lua table whose % first component is a ``catcode table'' and the second element a string. The % string will be sent to LaTeX with the regime of catcodes specified by the % catcode table. If no catcode table is provided, the standard catcodes of LaTeX % will be used.} % % \bigskip % Consider, for example, the following Python code: % % \begin{Piton} % def parity(x): % return x%2 % \end{Piton} % % The capture returned by the \pkg{lpeg} |python| against that code is the % Lua table containing the following elements : % % \bigskip % \begin{minipage}{\linewidth} % \color{gray} % % |{ "\\__piton_begin_line:" }|\footnote{Each line of the Python listings will % be encapsulated in a pair: \texttt{\textbackslash_@@_begin_line:} -- % \texttt{\textbackslash@@_end_line:}. The token % \texttt{\textbackslash@@_end_line:} must be explicit because it will be used as % marker in order to delimit the argument of the command \texttt{\textbackslash % @@\_begin\_line:}. Both tokens \texttt{\textbackslash_@@_begin_line:} and % \texttt{\textbackslash@@_end_line:} will be nullified in the command % \texttt{\textbackslash piton} (since there can't be lines breaks in the % argument of a command \texttt{\textbackslash piton}).} % % \texttt{\{ "\{\textbackslash PitonStyle\{Keyword\}\{" \}}\footnote{The % lexical elements of Python for which we have a \pkg{piton} style will be % formatted via the use of the command \texttt{\textbackslash PitonStyle}. % Such an element is typeset in LaTeX via the syntax \texttt{\{\textbackslash % PitonStyle\{\textsl{style}\}\{...\}\}} because the instructions inside an \texttt{\textbackslash % PitonStyle} may be both semi-global declarations like % \texttt{\textbackslash bfseries} and commands with one argument like % \texttt{\textbackslash fbox}.} % % \texttt{\{ % luatexbase.catcodetables.CatcodeTableOther\footnote{\texttt{luatexbase.catcodetables.CatcodeTableOther} is a mere number which corresponds to the ``catcode table'' whose all characters have the catcode ``other'' (which means that they will be typeset by LaTeX verbatim).}, "def" \} } % % |{ "}}" }| % % |{ luatexbase.catcodetables.CatcodeTableOther, " " }| % % |{ "{\PitonStyle{Name.Function}{" }| % % |{ luatexbase.catcodetables.CatcodeTableOther, "parity" }| % % |{ "}}" }| % % |{ luatexbase.catcodetables.CatcodeTableOther, "(" }| % % |{ luatexbase.catcodetables.CatcodeTableOther, "x" }| % % |{ luatexbase.catcodetables.CatcodeTableOther, ")" }| % % |{ luatexbase.catcodetables.CatcodeTableOther, ":" }| % % |{ "\\__piton_end_line: \\__piton_newline: \\__piton_begin_line:" }| % % |{ luatexbase.catcodetables.CatcodeTableOther, " " }| % % |{ "{\PitonStyle{Keyword}{" }| % % |{ luatexbase.catcodetables.CatcodeTableOther, "return" }| % % |{ "}}" }| % % |{ luatexbase.catcodetables.CatcodeTableOther, " " }| % % |{ luatexbase.catcodetables.CatcodeTableOther, "x" }| % % |{ "{\PitonStyle{Operator}{" }| % % |{ luatexbase.catcodetables.CatcodeTableOther, "&" }| % % |{ "}}" }| % % |{ "{\PitonStyle{Number}{" }| % % |{ luatexbase.catcodetables.CatcodeTableOther, "2" }| % % |{ "}}" }| % % |{ "\\__piton_end_line:" }| % % \end{minipage} % % \bigskip % We give now the LaTeX code which is sent back by Lua to TeX (we have written % on several lines for legibility but no character |\r| will be sent to LaTeX). The % characters which are greyed-out are sent to LaTeX with the catcode ``other'' % (=12). All the others characters are sent with the regime of catcodes of L3 % (as set by |\ExplSyntaxOn|) % % % \begingroup % \def\gbox#1{\colorbox{gray!20}{\strut #1}} % \setlength{\fboxsep}{1pt} % % \begin{Verbatim*}[formatcom = \color{black}] % \__piton_begin_line:{\PitonStyle{Keyword}{~gbox#def@}} % ~gbox# @{\PitonStyle{Name.Function}{~gbox#parity@}}~gbox#(x):@\__piton_end_line:\__piton_newline: % \__piton_begin_line:~gbox# @{\PitonStyle{Keyword}{~gbox#return@}} % ~gbox# x@{\PitonStyle{Operator}{~gbox#%@}}{\PitonStyle{Number}{~gbox#2@}}\__piton_end_line: % \end{Verbatim*} % \endgroup % % % % % \subsection{The L3 part of the implementation} % % \subsubsection{Declaration of the package} % \begin{macrocode} %<*STY> \NeedsTeXFormat{LaTeX2e} \RequirePackage{l3keys2e} \ProvidesExplPackage {piton} {\PitonFileDate} {\PitonFileVersion} {Highlight informatic listings with LPEG on LuaLaTeX} % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % The command |\text| provided by the package \pkg{amstext} will be used to % allow the use of the command |\pion{...}| (with the standard syntax) in % mathematical mode. % \begin{macrocode} \RequirePackage { amstext } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_error:n { \msg_error:nn { piton } } \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_warning:n { \msg_warning:nn { piton } } \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_error:nn { \msg_error:nnn { piton } } \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_error:nnn { \msg_error:nnnn { piton } } \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_fatal:n { \msg_fatal:nn { piton } } \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_fatal:nn { \msg_fatal:nnn { piton } } \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_msg_new:nn { \msg_new:nnn { piton } } \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_gredirect_none:n #1 { \group_begin: \globaldefs = 1 \msg_redirect_name:nnn { piton } { #1 } { none } \group_end: } % \end{macrocode} % % With Overleaf, by default, a document is compiled in non-stop mode. When there % is an error, there is no way to the user to use the key H in order to have % more information. That's why we decide to put that piece of information (for % the messages with such information) in the main part of the message when the % key |messages-for-Overleaf| is used (at load-time). % \begin{macrocode} \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_msg_new:nnn #1 #2 #3 { \bool_if:NTF \g_@@_messages_for_Overleaf_bool { \msg_new:nnn { piton } { #1 } { #2 \\ #3 } } { \msg_new:nnnn { piton } { #1 } { #2 } { #3 } } } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % We also create a command which will generate usually an error but only a % warning on Overleaf. The argument is given by curryfication. % \begin{macrocode} \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_error_or_warning:n { \bool_if:NTF \g_@@_messages_for_Overleaf_bool \@@_warning:n \@@_error:n } % \end{macrocode} % % We try to detect whether the compilation is done on Overleaf. We use % |\c_sys_jobname_str| because, with Overleaf, the value of |\c_sys_jobname_str| % is always ``|output|''. % \begin{macrocode} \bool_new:N \g_@@_messages_for_Overleaf_bool \bool_gset:Nn \g_@@_messages_for_Overleaf_bool { \str_if_eq_p:on \c_sys_jobname_str { _region_ } % for Emacs || \str_if_eq_p:on \c_sys_jobname_str { output } % for Overleaf } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} \@@_msg_new:nn { LuaLaTeX~mandatory } { LuaLaTeX~is~mandatory.\\ The~package~'piton'~requires~the~engine~LuaLaTeX.\\ \str_if_eq:onT \c_sys_jobname_str { output } { If~you~use~Overleaf,~you~can~switch~to~LuaLaTeX~in~the~"Menu". \\} If~you~go~on,~the~package~'piton'~won't~be~loaded. } \sys_if_engine_luatex:F { \msg_critical:nn { piton } { LuaLaTeX~mandatory } } % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} \RequirePackage { luatexbase } \RequirePackage { luacode } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} \@@_msg_new:nnn { piton.lua~not~found } { The~file~'piton.lua'~can't~be~found.\\ This~error~is~fatal.\\ If~you~want~to~know~how~to~retrieve~the~file~'piton.lua',~type~H~. } { On~the~site~CTAN,~go~to~the~page~of~'piton':~https://ctan.org/pkg/piton.~ The~file~'README.md'~explains~how~to~retrieve~the~files~'piton.sty'~and~ 'piton.lua'. } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} \file_if_exist:nF { piton.lua } { \@@_fatal:n { piton.lua~not~found } } % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % The boolean |\g_@@_footnotehyper_bool| will indicate if the option % |footnotehyper| is used. % \begin{macrocode} \bool_new:N \g_@@_footnotehyper_bool % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % The boolean |\g_@@_footnote_bool| will indicate if the option |footnote| is % used, but quickly, it will also be set to |true| if the option |footnotehyper| % is used. % \begin{macrocode} \bool_new:N \g_@@_footnote_bool % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % The following boolean corresponds to the key |math-comments| (available only % in the preamble of the LaTeX document). % \begin{macrocode} \bool_new:N \g_@@_math_comments_bool % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % \begin{macrocode} \bool_new:N \g_@@_beamer_bool \tl_new:N \g_@@_escape_inside_tl % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % In version 4.0 of \pkg{piton}, we changed the mechanism used by \pkg{piton} % to search the file to load with |\PitonInputFile|. With the key % |old-PitonInputFile|, it's possible to keep the old behaviour but it's only % for backward compatibility and it will be deleted in a future version. % \begin{macrocode} \bool_new:N \l_@@_old_PitonInputFile_bool % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % We define a set of keys for the options at load-time. % \begin{macrocode} \keys_define:nn { piton / package } { footnote .bool_gset:N = \g_@@_footnote_bool , footnotehyper .bool_gset:N = \g_@@_footnotehyper_bool , footnote .usage:n = load , footnotehyper .usage:n = load , beamer .bool_gset:N = \g_@@_beamer_bool , beamer .default:n = true , beamer .usage:n = load , % \end{macrocode} % \medskip % In version 4.0 of \pkg{piton}, we changed the mechanism used by \pkg{piton} % to search the file to load with |\PitonInputFile|. With the key % |old-PitonInputFile|, it's possible to keep the old behaviour but it's only % for backward compatibility and it will be deleted in a future version. % \begin{macrocode} old-PitonInputFile .bool_set:N = \l_@@_old_PitonInputFile_bool , old-PitonInputFile .default:n = true , old-PitonInputFile .usage:n = load , unknown .code:n = \@@_error:n { Unknown~key~for~package } } % \end{macrocode} % % % % \begin{macrocode} \@@_msg_new:nn { Unknown~key~for~package } { Unknown~key.\\ You~have~used~the~key~'\l_keys_key_str'~but~the~only~keys~available~here~ are~'beamer',~'footnote',~'footnotehyper'~and~'old-PitonInputFile'.~ Other~keys~are~available~in~\token_to_str:N \PitonOptions.\\ That~key~will~be~ignored. } % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % We process the options provided by the user at load-time. % \begin{macrocode} \ProcessKeysOptions { piton / package } % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} \msg_new:nnn { piton } { old-PitonInputFile } { Be~careful:~The~key~'old-PitonInputFile'~will~be~deleted~ in~a~future~version~of~'piton'. } \bool_if:NT \l_@@_old_PitonInputFile_bool { \msg_warning:nn { piton } { old-PitonInputFile } } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} \IfClassLoadedTF { beamer } { \bool_gset_true:N \g_@@_beamer_bool } { } \IfPackageLoadedTF { beamerarticle } { \bool_gset_true:N \g_@@_beamer_bool } { } \lua_now:n { piton = piton~or~{ } } \bool_if:NT \g_@@_beamer_bool { \lua_now:n { piton.beamer = true } } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} \hook_gput_code:nnn { begindocument / before } { . } { \IfPackageLoadedTF { xcolor } { } { \usepackage { xcolor } } } % \end{macrocode} % % % \begin{macrocode} \@@_msg_new:nn { footnote~with~footnotehyper~package } { Footnote~forbidden.\\ You~can't~use~the~option~'footnote'~because~the~package~ footnotehyper~has~already~been~loaded.~ If~you~want,~you~can~use~the~option~'footnotehyper'~and~the~footnotes~ within~the~environments~of~piton~will~be~extracted~with~the~tools~ of~the~package~footnotehyper.\\ If~you~go~on,~the~package~footnote~won't~be~loaded. } % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} \@@_msg_new:nn { footnotehyper~with~footnote~package } { You~can't~use~the~option~'footnotehyper'~because~the~package~ footnote~has~already~been~loaded.~ If~you~want,~you~can~use~the~option~'footnote'~and~the~footnotes~ within~the~environments~of~piton~will~be~extracted~with~the~tools~ of~the~package~footnote.\\ If~you~go~on,~the~package~footnotehyper~won't~be~loaded. } % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % \begin{macrocode} \bool_if:NT \g_@@_footnote_bool { % \end{macrocode} % The class \cls{beamer} has its own system to extract footnotes and that's why % we have nothing to do if \cls{beamer} is used. % \begin{macrocode} \IfClassLoadedTF { beamer } { \bool_gset_false:N \g_@@_footnote_bool } { \IfPackageLoadedTF { footnotehyper } { \@@_error:n { footnote~with~footnotehyper~package } } { \usepackage { footnote } } } } % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} \bool_if:NT \g_@@_footnotehyper_bool { % \end{macrocode} % The class \cls{beamer} has its own system to extract footnotes and that's why % we have nothing to do if \cls{beamer} is used. % \begin{macrocode} \IfClassLoadedTF { beamer } { \bool_gset_false:N \g_@@_footnote_bool } { \IfPackageLoadedTF { footnote } { \@@_error:n { footnotehyper~with~footnote~package } } { \usepackage { footnotehyper } } \bool_gset_true:N \g_@@_footnote_bool } } % \end{macrocode} % The flag |\g_@@_footnote_bool| is raised and so, we will only have to test % |\g_@@_footnote_bool| in order to know if we have to insert an environment % |{savenotes}|. % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} \lua_now:n { piton.BeamerCommands = lpeg.P [[\uncover]] + [[\only]] + [[\visible]] + [[\invisible]] + [[\alert]] + [[\action]] piton.beamer_environments = { "uncoverenv" , "onlyenv" , "visibleenv" , "invisibleenv" , "alertenv" , "actionenv" } piton.DetectedCommands = lpeg.P ( false ) piton.last_code = '' piton.last_language = '' } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \subsubsection{Parameters and technical definitions} % % The following string will contain the name of the informatic language % considered (the initial value is |python|). % % \begin{macrocode} \str_new:N \l_piton_language_str \str_set:Nn \l_piton_language_str { python } % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % Each time an environment of \pkg{piton} is used, the informatic code in the % body of that environment will be stored in the following global string. % \begin{macrocode} \tl_new:N \g_piton_last_code_tl % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % The following parameter corresponds to the key |path| (which is the path used % to include files by |\PitonInputFile|). Each component of that sequence will % be a string (type |str|). % \begin{macrocode} \seq_new:N \l_@@_path_seq % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % The following parameter corresponds to the key |path-write| (which is the path % used when writing files from listings inserted in the environments of % \pkg{piton} by use of the key |write|). % \begin{macrocode} \str_new:N \l_@@_path_write_str % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % In order to have a better control over the keys. % \begin{macrocode} \bool_new:N \l_@@_in_PitonOptions_bool \bool_new:N \l_@@_in_PitonInputFile_bool % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % The following parameter corresponds to the key |font-command|. % \begin{macrocode} \tl_new:N \l_@@_font_command_tl \tl_set:Nn \l_@@_font_command_tl { \ttfamily } % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % We will compute (with Lua) the numbers of lines of the listings (or % \emph{chunks} of listings when |split-on-empty-lines| is in force) and store % it in the following counter. % \begin{macrocode} \int_new:N \l_@@_nb_lines_int % \end{macrocode} % % The same for the number of non-empty lines of the listings. % \begin{macrocode} \int_new:N \l_@@_nb_non_empty_lines_int % \end{macrocode} % % % \medskip % The following counter will be used to count the lines during the composition. % It will take into account all the lines, empty or not empty. It won't be used % to print the numbers of the lines but will be used to allow or disallow line % breaks (when |splittable| is in force) and for the color of the background % (when |background-color| is used with a \emph{list} of colors). % \begin{macrocode} \int_new:N \g_@@_line_int % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % The following token list will contain the (potential) information to write % on the |aux| (to be used in the next compilation). The technic of the % auxiliary file will be used when the key |width| is used with the value~|min|. % \begin{macrocode} \tl_new:N \g_@@_aux_tl % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % The following counter corresponds to the key |splittable| of |\PitonOptions|. % If the value of |\l_@@_splittable_int| is equal to $n$, then no line break can % occur within the first $n$~lines or the last $n$~lines of a listing (or a % \emph{chunk} of listings when the key |split-on-empty-lines| is in force). % \begin{macrocode} \int_new:N \l_@@_splittable_int % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % An initial value of |splittable| equal to 100 is equivalent to say that the % environments |{Piton}| are unbreakable. % \begin{macrocode} \int_set:Nn \l_@@_splittable_int { 100 } % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % When the key |split-on-empty-lines| will be in force, then the following token % list will be inserted between the chunks of code (the informatic code provided % by the final user is split in chunks on the empty lines in the code). % \begin{macrocode} \tl_new:N \l_@@_split_separation_tl \tl_set:Nn \l_@@_split_separation_tl { \vspace { \baselineskip } \vspace { -1.25pt } } % \end{macrocode} % That parameter must contain elements to be inserted in \emph{vertical} mode by % TeX. % % % \medskip % The following string corresponds to the key |background-color| of |\PitonOptions|. % \begin{macrocode} \clist_new:N \l_@@_bg_color_clist % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % The package \pkg{piton} will also detect the lines of code which correspond to % the user input in a Python console, that is to say the lines of code beginning % with |>>>| and |...|. It's possible, with the key |prompt-background-color|, % to require a background for these lines of code (and the other lines of code % will have the standard background color specified by |background-color|). % \begin{macrocode} \tl_new:N \l_@@_prompt_bg_color_tl % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % The following parameters correspond to the keys |begin-range| and |end-range| of % the command |\PitonInputFile|. % \begin{macrocode} \str_new:N \l_@@_begin_range_str \str_new:N \l_@@_end_range_str % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % The argument of |\PitonInputFile|. % \begin{macrocode} \str_new:N \l_@@_file_name_str % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % We will count the environments |{Piton}| (and, in fact, also the commands % |\PitonInputFile|, despite the name |\g_@@_env_int|). % \begin{macrocode} \int_new:N \g_@@_env_int % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % The parameter |\l_@@_writer_str| corresponds to the key |write|. We will store % the list of the files already used in |\g_@@_write_seq| (we must not erase a % file which has been still been used). % \begin{macrocode} \str_new:N \l_@@_write_str \seq_new:N \g_@@_write_seq % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % The following boolean corresponds to the key |show-spaces|. % \begin{macrocode} \bool_new:N \l_@@_show_spaces_bool % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % The following booleans correspond to the keys |break-lines| and % |indent-broken-lines|. % \begin{macrocode} \bool_new:N \l_@@_break_lines_in_Piton_bool \bool_new:N \l_@@_indent_broken_lines_bool % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % The following token list corresponds to the key |continuation-symbol|. % \begin{macrocode} \tl_new:N \l_@@_continuation_symbol_tl \tl_set:Nn \l_@@_continuation_symbol_tl { + } % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % The following token list corresponds to the key % |continuation-symbol-on-indentation|. The name has been shorten to |csoi|. % \begin{macrocode} \tl_new:N \l_@@_csoi_tl \tl_set:Nn \l_@@_csoi_tl { $ \hookrightarrow \; $ } % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % The following token list corresponds to the key |end-of-broken-line|. % \begin{macrocode} \tl_new:N \l_@@_end_of_broken_line_tl \tl_set:Nn \l_@@_end_of_broken_line_tl { \hspace*{0.5em} \textbackslash } % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % The following boolean corresponds to the key |break-lines-in-piton|. % \begin{macrocode} \bool_new:N \l_@@_break_lines_in_piton_bool % \end{macrocode} % However, the key |break-lines_in_piton| raises that boolean but also executes the % following instruction: % % \quad |\tl_set_eq:NN \l_@@_space_in_string_tl \space| % The initial value of |\l_@@_space_in_string_tl| is |\nobreakspace|. % % \bigskip % The following dimension will be the width of the listing constructed by % |{Piton}| or |\PitonInputFile|. % \begin{itemize} % \item If the user uses the key |width| of |\PitonOptions| with a numerical % value, that value will be stored in |\l_@@_width_dim|. % \item If the user uses the key |width| with the special value~|min|, the % dimension |\l_@@_width_dim| will, \emph{in the second run}, be computed from % the value of |\l_@@_line_width_dim| stored in the |aux| file % (computed during the first run the maximal width of the lines of the listing). % During the first run, |\l_@@_width_line_dim| will be set equal to |\linewidth|. % \item Elsewhere, |\l_@@_width_dim| will be set at the beginning of the listing % (in |\@@_pre_env:|) equal to the current value of |\linewidth|. % \end{itemize} % % \begin{macrocode} \dim_new:N \l_@@_width_dim % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % We will also use another dimension called |\l_@@_line_width_dim|. That % will the width of the actual lines of code. That dimension may be lower than % the whole |\l_@@_width_dim| because we have to take into account the value of % |\l_@@_left_margin_dim| (for the numbers of lines when |line-numbers| is in % force) and another small margin when a background color is used (with the key % |background-color|). % \begin{macrocode} \dim_new:N \l_@@_line_width_dim % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % The following flag will be raised with the key |width| is used with the % special value |min|. % \begin{macrocode} \bool_new:N \l_@@_width_min_bool % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % If the key |width| is used with the special value~|min|, we will compute the % maximal width of the lines of an environment |{Piton}| in |\g_@@_tmp_width_dim| % because we need it for the case of the key |width| is used with the special % value |min|. We need a global variable because, when the key |footnote| is in % force, each line when be composed in an environment |{savenotes}| and we need % to exit our |\g_@@_tmp_width_dim| from that environment. % \begin{macrocode} \dim_new:N \g_@@_tmp_width_dim % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % The following dimension corresponds to the key |left-margin| of |\PitonOptions|. % \begin{macrocode} \dim_new:N \l_@@_left_margin_dim % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % The following boolean will be set when the key |left-margin=auto| % is used. % \begin{macrocode} \bool_new:N \l_@@_left_margin_auto_bool % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % The following dimension corresponds to the key |numbers-sep| of % |\PitonOptions|. % \begin{macrocode} \dim_new:N \l_@@_numbers_sep_dim \dim_set:Nn \l_@@_numbers_sep_dim { 0.7 em } % \end{macrocode} % % % \medskip % Be careful. The following sequence |\g_@@_languages_seq| is not the list of % the languages supported by \pkg{piton}. It's the list of the languages for % which at least a user function has been defined. We need that sequence only % for the command |\PitonClearUserFunctions| when it is used without its % optional argument: it must clear all the list of languages for which at least % a user function has been defined. % \begin{macrocode} \seq_new:N \g_@@_languages_seq % \end{macrocode} % % % \medskip % \begin{macrocode} \int_new:N \l_@@_tab_size_int \int_set:Nn \l_@@_tab_size_int { 4 } % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_tab: { \bool_if:NTF \l_@@_show_spaces_bool { \hbox_set:Nn \l_tmpa_box { \prg_replicate:nn \l_@@_tab_size_int { ~ } } \dim_set:Nn \l_tmpa_dim { \box_wd:N \l_tmpa_box } \( \mathcolor { gray } { \hbox_to_wd:nn \l_tmpa_dim { \rightarrowfill } } \) } { \hbox:n { \prg_replicate:nn \l_@@_tab_size_int { ~ } } } \int_gadd:Nn \g_@@_indentation_int \l_@@_tab_size_int } % \end{macrocode} % % % \medskip % The following integer corresponds to the key |gobble|. % \begin{macrocode} \int_new:N \l_@@_gobble_int % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % The following token list will be used only for the spaces in the strings. % \begin{macrocode} \tl_set_eq:NN \l_@@_space_in_string_tl \nobreakspace % \end{macrocode} % When the key |break-lines-in-piton| is set, that parameter will be replaced by % |\space| (in |\piton| with the standard syntax) and when the key % |show-spaces-in-strings| is set, it will be replaced by ␣ (U+2423). % % % \medskip % At each line, the following counter will count the spaces at the beginning. % \begin{macrocode} \int_new:N \g_@@_indentation_int % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % Be careful: when executed, the following command does \emph{not} create a % space (only an incrementation of the counter). % \begin{macrocode} \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_leading_space: { \int_gincr:N \g_@@_indentation_int } % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % In the environment |{Piton}|, the command |\label| will be linked to the % following command. % \begin{macrocode} \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_label:n #1 { \bool_if:NTF \l_@@_line_numbers_bool { \@bsphack \protected@write \@auxout { } { \string \newlabel { #1 } { % \end{macrocode} % Remember that the content of a line is typeset in a box \emph{before} the % composition of the potential number of line. % \begin{macrocode} { \int_eval:n { \g_@@_visual_line_int + 1 } } { \thepage } } } \@esphack } { \@@_error:n { label~with~lines~numbers } } } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % The following commands corresponds to the keys |marker/beginning| and % |marker/end|. The values of that keys are functions that will be applied to % the ``\emph{range}'' specified by the final user in an individual % |\PitonInputFile|. They will construct the markers used to find textually in % the external file loaded by \pkg{piton} the part which must be included (and % formatted). % \begin{macrocode} \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_marker_beginning:n #1 { } \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_marker_end:n #1 { } % \end{macrocode} % % % % \bigskip % The following token list will be evaluated at the beginning of % |\@@_begin_line:|... |\@@_end_line:| and cleared at the end. It will be used % by LPEG acting between the lines of the Python code in order to add % instructions to be executed at the beginning of the line. % \begin{macrocode} \tl_new:N \g_@@_begin_line_hook_tl % \end{macrocode} % % \smallskip % For example, the LPEG |Prompt| will trigger the following command which will % insert an instruction in the hook |\g_@@_begin_line_hook| to specify that a % background must be inserted to the current line of code. % \begin{macrocode} \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_prompt: { \tl_gset:Nn \g_@@_begin_line_hook_tl { \tl_if_empty:NF \l_@@_prompt_bg_color_tl { \clist_set:No \l_@@_bg_color_clist \l_@@_prompt_bg_color_tl } } } % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % The spaces at the end of a line of code are deleted by \pkg{piton}. % However, it's not actually true: they are replace by |\@@_trailing_space:|. % \begin{macrocode} \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_trailing_space: { } % \end{macrocode} % When we have to rescan some pieces of code, we will use |\@@_piton:n|, which % we will set |\@@_trailing_space:| equal to |\space|. % % \bigskip % \subsubsection{Treatment of a line of code} % % \begin{macrocode} \cs_generate_variant:Nn \@@_replace_spaces:n { o } \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_replace_spaces:n #1 { \tl_set:Nn \l_tmpa_tl { #1 } \bool_if:NTF \l_@@_show_spaces_bool { \tl_set:Nn \l_@@_space_in_string_tl { ␣ } % U+2423 \regex_replace_all:nnN { \x20 } { ␣ } \l_tmpa_tl } { % \end{macrocode} % If the key |break-lines-in-Piton| is in force, we replace all the characters % U+0020 (that is to say the spaces) by |\@@_breakable_space:|. Remark that, % except the spaces inserted in the LaTeX comments (and maybe in the math % comments), all these spaces are of catcode ``other'' (=12) and are % unbreakable. % \begin{macrocode} \bool_if:NT \l_@@_break_lines_in_Piton_bool { \regex_replace_all:nnN { \x20 } { \c { @@_breakable_space: } } \l_tmpa_tl \regex_replace_all:nnN { \c { l_@@_space_in_string_tl } } { \c { @@_breakable_space: } } \l_tmpa_tl } } \l_tmpa_tl } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % In the contents provided by Lua, each line of the Python code will be % surrounded by |\@@_begin_line:| and |\@@_end_line:|. % |\@@_begin_line:| is a % TeX command with a delimited argument (|\@@_end_line:| is the marker for the % end of the argument). % % However, we define also |\@@_end_line:| as no-op, because, when the last line % of the listing is the end of an environment of Beamer (eg |\end{uncoverenv}|), % we will have a token |\@@_end_line:| added at the end without any % corresponding |\@@_begin_line:|). % \begin{macrocode} \cs_set_protected:Npn \@@_end_line: { } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} \cs_set_protected:Npn \@@_begin_line: #1 \@@_end_line: { \group_begin: \g_@@_begin_line_hook_tl \int_gzero:N \g_@@_indentation_int % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % First, we will put in the coffin |\l_tmpa_coffin| the actual content of a line % of the code (without the potential number of line). % % Be careful: There is curryfication in the following code. % \begin{macrocode} \bool_if:NTF \l_@@_width_min_bool \@@_put_in_coffin_ii:n \@@_put_in_coffin_i:n { \language = -1 \raggedright \strut \@@_replace_spaces:n { #1 } \strut \hfil } % \end{macrocode} % Now, we add the potential number of line, the potential left margin and the % potential background. % \begin{macrocode} \hbox_set:Nn \l_tmpa_box { \skip_horizontal:N \l_@@_left_margin_dim \bool_if:NT \l_@@_line_numbers_bool { % \end{macrocode} % |\l_tmpa_int| will be true equal to $1$ when the current line is not empty. % \begin{macrocode} \int_set:Nn \l_tmpa_int { \lua_now:e { tex.sprint ( luatexbase.catcodetables.expl , % \end{macrocode} % Since the argument of |tostring| will be a integer of Lua (\emph{integer} is a % sub-type of \emph{number} introduced in Lua 5.3), the output will be of the % form |"3"| (and not |"3.0"|) which is what we want for |\int_set:Nn|. % \begin{macrocode} tostring ( piton.empty_lines [ \int_eval:n { \g_@@_line_int + 1 } ] ) ) } } \bool_lazy_or:nnT { \int_compare_p:nNn \l_tmpa_int = \c_one_int } { ! \l_@@_skip_empty_lines_bool } { \int_gincr:N \g_@@_visual_line_int } \bool_lazy_or:nnT { \int_compare_p:nNn \l_tmpa_int = \c_one_int } { ! \l_@@_skip_empty_lines_bool && \l_@@_label_empty_lines_bool } \@@_print_number: } % \end{macrocode} % If there is a background, we must remind that there is a left margin of 0.5~em % for the background... % \begin{macrocode} \clist_if_empty:NF \l_@@_bg_color_clist { % \end{macrocode} % ... but if only if the key |left-margin| is not used ! % \begin{macrocode} \dim_compare:nNnT \l_@@_left_margin_dim = \c_zero_dim { \skip_horizontal:n { 0.5 em } } } \coffin_typeset:Nnnnn \l_tmpa_coffin T l \c_zero_dim \c_zero_dim } \box_set_dp:Nn \l_tmpa_box { \box_dp:N \l_tmpa_box + 1.25 pt } \box_set_ht:Nn \l_tmpa_box { \box_ht:N \l_tmpa_box + 1.25 pt } % \end{macrocode} % We have to explicitely begin a paragraph because we will insert a TeX box (and % we don't want that box to be inserted in the vertical list). % \begin{macrocode} \mode_leave_vertical: \clist_if_empty:NTF \l_@@_bg_color_clist { \box_use_drop:N \l_tmpa_box } { \vtop { \hbox:n { \@@_color:N \l_@@_bg_color_clist \vrule height \box_ht:N \l_tmpa_box depth \box_dp:N \l_tmpa_box width \l_@@_width_dim } \skip_vertical:n { - \box_ht_plus_dp:N \l_tmpa_box } \box_use_drop:N \l_tmpa_box } } \group_end: \tl_gclear:N \g_@@_begin_line_hook_tl } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % In the general case (which is also the simpler), the key |width| is not used, % or (if used) it is not used with the special value~|min|. % In that case, the content of a line of code is composed in a vertical coffin % with a width equal to |\l_@@_line_width_dim|. That coffin may, % eventually, contains several lines when the key |break-lines-in-Piton| (or % |break-lines|) is used. % % That commands takes in its argument by curryfication. % \begin{macrocode} \cs_set_protected:Npn \@@_put_in_coffin_i:n { \vcoffin_set:Nnn \l_tmpa_coffin \l_@@_line_width_dim } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % The second case is the case when the key |width| is used with the special % value~|min|. % \begin{macrocode} \cs_set_protected:Npn \@@_put_in_coffin_ii:n #1 { % \end{macrocode} % First, we compute the natural width of the line of code because we have to % compute the natural width of the whole listing (and it will be written on the % |aux| file in the variable |\l_@@_width_dim|). % \begin{macrocode} \hbox_set:Nn \l_tmpa_box { #1 } % \end{macrocode} % Now, you can actualize the value of |\g_@@_tmp_width_dim| (it will be used to % write on the |aux| file the natural width of the environment). % \begin{macrocode} \dim_compare:nNnT { \box_wd:N \l_tmpa_box } > \g_@@_tmp_width_dim { \dim_gset:Nn \g_@@_tmp_width_dim { \box_wd:N \l_tmpa_box } } % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} \hcoffin_set:Nn \l_tmpa_coffin { \hbox_to_wd:nn \l_@@_line_width_dim % \end{macrocode} % We unpack the block in order to free the potential |\hfill| springs present in % the LaTeX comments (cf. section~\ref{example-comments}, p.~\pageref{example-comments}). % \begin{macrocode} { \hbox_unpack:N \l_tmpa_box \hfil } } } % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % The command |\@@_color:N| will take in as argument a reference to a % comma-separated list of colors. A color will be picked by using the value of % |\g_@@_line_int| (modulo the number of colors in the list). % \begin{macrocode} \cs_set_protected:Npn \@@_color:N #1 { \int_set:Nn \l_tmpa_int { \clist_count:N #1 } \int_set:Nn \l_tmpb_int { \int_mod:nn \g_@@_line_int \l_tmpa_int + 1 } \tl_set:Ne \l_tmpa_tl { \clist_item:Nn #1 \l_tmpb_int } \tl_if_eq:NnTF \l_tmpa_tl { none } % \end{macrocode} % By setting |\l_@@_width_dim| to zero, the colored rectangle will be % drawn with zero width and, thus, it will be a mere strut (and we need that strut). % \begin{macrocode} { \dim_zero:N \l_@@_width_dim } { \@@_color_i:o \l_tmpa_tl } } % \end{macrocode} % % The following command |\@@_color:n| will accept both the instruction % |\@@_color:n { red!15 }| and the instruction |\@@_color:n { [rgb]{0.9,0.9,0} }|. % \begin{macrocode} \cs_generate_variant:Nn \@@_color_i:n { o } \cs_set_protected:Npn \@@_color_i:n #1 { \tl_if_head_eq_meaning:nNTF { #1 } [ { \tl_set:Nn \l_tmpa_tl { #1 } \tl_set_rescan:Nno \l_tmpa_tl { } \l_tmpa_tl \exp_last_unbraced:No \color \l_tmpa_tl } { \color { #1 } } } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % The command |\@@_newline:| will be inserted by Lua between two lines of the % informatic listing. % \begin{itemize} % \item In fact, it will be inserted between two commands % |\@@_begin_line:|...|\@@_end_of_line:|. % \item When the key |break-lines-in-Piton| is in force, a line of the % informatic code (the \emph{input}) may result in several lines in the % \textsc{pdf} (the \emph{output}). % \item Remind that |\@@_newline:| has a rather complex behaviour because it will % finish and start paragraphs. % \end{itemize} % \begin{macrocode} \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_newline: { \bool_if:NT \g_@@_footnote_bool \endsavenotes % \end{macrocode} % We recall that |\g_@@_line_int| is \emph{not} used for the number of line % printed in the \textsc{pdf} (when |line-numbers| is in force)... % \begin{macrocode} \int_gincr:N \g_@@_line_int % \end{macrocode} % ... it will be used to allow or disallow page breaks. % % % Each line in the listing is composed in a box of TeX (which may contain % several lines when the key |break-lines-in-Piton| is in force) put in a % paragraph. % \begin{macrocode} \par % \end{macrocode} % We now add a |\kern| because each line of code is overlapping vertically by a % quantity of 2.5~pt in order to have a good background (when |background-color| % is in force). We need to use a |\kern| (in fact |\par\kern...|) and not a % |\vskip| because page breaks should \emph{not} be allowed on that kern. % \begin{macrocode} \kern -2.5 pt % \end{macrocode} % Now, we control page breaks after the paragraph. We use the Lua table % |piton.lines_status| which has been written by |piton.ComputeLinesStatus| for % this aim. Each line has a ``status`` (equal to 0, 1 or 2) and that status % directly says whether a break is allowed. % \begin{macrocode} \int_case:nn { \lua_now:e { tex.sprint ( luatexbase.catcodetables.expl , tostring ( piton.lines_status [ \int_use:N \g_@@_line_int ] ) ) } } { 1 { \penalty 100 } 2 \nobreak } % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} \bool_if:NT \g_@@_footnote_bool \savenotes % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} } % \end{macrocode} % After the command |\@@_newline:|, we will usually have a command |\@@_begin_line:|. % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} \cs_set_protected:Npn \@@_breakable_space: { \discretionary { \hbox:n { \color { gray } \l_@@_end_of_broken_line_tl } } { \hbox_overlap_left:n { { \normalfont \footnotesize \color { gray } \l_@@_continuation_symbol_tl } \skip_horizontal:n { 0.3 em } \clist_if_empty:NF \l_@@_bg_color_clist { \skip_horizontal:n { 0.5 em } } } \bool_if:NT \l_@@_indent_broken_lines_bool { \hbox:n { \prg_replicate:nn { \g_@@_indentation_int } { ~ } { \color { gray } \l_@@_csoi_tl } } } } { \hbox { ~ } } } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \subsubsection{PitonOptions} % % % % \medskip % \begin{macrocode} \bool_new:N \l_@@_line_numbers_bool \bool_new:N \l_@@_skip_empty_lines_bool \bool_set_true:N \l_@@_skip_empty_lines_bool \bool_new:N \l_@@_line_numbers_absolute_bool \tl_new:N \l_@@_line_numbers_format_bool \tl_set:Nn \l_@@_line_numbers_format_tl { \footnotesize \color { gray } } \bool_new:N \l_@@_label_empty_lines_bool \bool_set_true:N \l_@@_label_empty_lines_bool \int_new:N \l_@@_number_lines_start_int \bool_new:N \l_@@_resume_bool \bool_new:N \l_@@_split_on_empty_lines_bool \bool_new:N \l_@@_splittable_on_empty_lines_bool % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} \keys_define:nn { PitonOptions / marker } { beginning .code:n = \cs_set:Nn \@@_marker_beginning:n { #1 } , beginning .value_required:n = true , end .code:n = \cs_set:Nn \@@_marker_end:n { #1 } , end .value_required:n = true , include-lines .bool_set:N = \l_@@_marker_include_lines_bool , include-lines .default:n = true , unknown .code:n = \@@_error:n { Unknown~key~for~marker } } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} \keys_define:nn { PitonOptions / line-numbers } { true .code:n = \bool_set_true:N \l_@@_line_numbers_bool , false .code:n = \bool_set_false:N \l_@@_line_numbers_bool , start .code:n = \bool_set_true:N \l_@@_line_numbers_bool \int_set:Nn \l_@@_number_lines_start_int { #1 } , start .value_required:n = true , skip-empty-lines .code:n = \bool_if:NF \l_@@_in_PitonOptions_bool { \bool_set_true:N \l_@@_line_numbers_bool } \str_if_eq:nnTF { #1 } { false } { \bool_set_false:N \l_@@_skip_empty_lines_bool } { \bool_set_true:N \l_@@_skip_empty_lines_bool } , skip-empty-lines .default:n = true , label-empty-lines .code:n = \bool_if:NF \l_@@_in_PitonOptions_bool { \bool_set_true:N \l_@@_line_numbers_bool } \str_if_eq:nnTF { #1 } { false } { \bool_set_false:N \l_@@_label_empty_lines_bool } { \bool_set_true:N \l_@@_label_empty_lines_bool } , label-empty-lines .default:n = true , absolute .code:n = \bool_if:NTF \l_@@_in_PitonOptions_bool { \bool_set_true:N \l_@@_line_numbers_absolute_bool } { \bool_set_true:N \l_@@_line_numbers_bool } \bool_if:NT \l_@@_in_PitonInputFile_bool { \bool_set_true:N \l_@@_line_numbers_absolute_bool \bool_set_false:N \l_@@_skip_empty_lines_bool } , absolute .value_forbidden:n = true , resume .code:n = \bool_set_true:N \l_@@_resume_bool \bool_if:NF \l_@@_in_PitonOptions_bool { \bool_set_true:N \l_@@_line_numbers_bool } , resume .value_forbidden:n = true , sep .dim_set:N = \l_@@_numbers_sep_dim , sep .value_required:n = true , format .tl_set:N = \l_@@_line_numbers_format_tl , format .value_required:n = true , unknown .code:n = \@@_error:n { Unknown~key~for~line-numbers } } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % Be careful! The name of the following set of keys must be considered as % public! Hence, it should \emph{not} be changed. % % \begin{macrocode} \keys_define:nn { PitonOptions } { break-strings-anywhere .bool_set:N = \l_@@_break_strings_anywhere_bool , break-strings-anywhere .default:n = true , break-numbers-anywhere .bool_set:N = \l_@@_break_numbers_anywhere_bool , break-numbers-anywhere .default:n = true , % \end{macrocode} % First, we put keys that should be available only in the preamble. % \begin{macrocode} detected-commands .code:n = \lua_now:n { piton.addDetectedCommands('#1') } , detected-commands .value_required:n = true , detected-commands .usage:n = preamble , detected-beamer-commands .code:n = \lua_now:n { piton.addBeamerCommands('#1') } , detected-beamer-commands .value_required:n = true , detected-beamer-commands .usage:n = preamble , detected-beamer-environments .code:n = \lua_now:n { piton.addBeamerEnvironments('#1') } , detected-beamer-environments .value_required:n = true , detected-beamer-environments .usage:n = preamble , % \end{macrocode} % % % Remark that the command |\lua_escape:n| is fully expandable. That's why we use % |\lua_now:e|. % \begin{macrocode} begin-escape .code:n = \lua_now:e { piton.begin_escape = "\lua_escape:n{#1}" } , begin-escape .value_required:n = true , begin-escape .usage:n = preamble , end-escape .code:n = \lua_now:e { piton.end_escape = "\lua_escape:n{#1}" } , end-escape .value_required:n = true , end-escape .usage:n = preamble , begin-escape-math .code:n = \lua_now:e { piton.begin_escape_math = "\lua_escape:n{#1}" } , begin-escape-math .value_required:n = true , begin-escape-math .usage:n = preamble , end-escape-math .code:n = \lua_now:e { piton.end_escape_math = "\lua_escape:n{#1}" } , end-escape-math .value_required:n = true , end-escape-math .usage:n = preamble , comment-latex .code:n = \lua_now:n { comment_latex = "#1" } , comment-latex .value_required:n = true , comment-latex .usage:n = preamble , math-comments .bool_gset:N = \g_@@_math_comments_bool , math-comments .default:n = true , math-comments .usage:n = preamble , % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % Now, general keys. % \begin{macrocode} language .code:n = \str_set:Ne \l_piton_language_str { \str_lowercase:n { #1 } } , language .value_required:n = true , path .code:n = \seq_clear:N \l_@@_path_seq \clist_map_inline:nn { #1 } { \str_set:Nn \l_tmpa_str { ##1 } \seq_put_right:No \l_@@_path_seq \l_tmpa_str } , path .value_required:n = true , % \end{macrocode} % The initial value of the key |path| is not empty: it's |.|, that is to say a % comma separated list with only one component which is |.|, the current directory. % \begin{macrocode} path .initial:n = . , path-write .str_set:N = \l_@@_path_write_str , path-write .value_required:n = true , font-command .tl_set:N = \l_@@_font_command_tl , font-command .value_required:n = true , gobble .int_set:N = \l_@@_gobble_int , gobble .value_required:n = true , auto-gobble .code:n = \int_set:Nn \l_@@_gobble_int { -1 } , auto-gobble .value_forbidden:n = true , env-gobble .code:n = \int_set:Nn \l_@@_gobble_int { -2 } , env-gobble .value_forbidden:n = true , tabs-auto-gobble .code:n = \int_set:Nn \l_@@_gobble_int { -3 } , tabs-auto-gobble .value_forbidden:n = true , splittable-on-empty-lines .bool_set:N = \l_@@_splittable_on_empty_lines_bool , splittable-on-empty-lines .default:n = true , split-on-empty-lines .bool_set:N = \l_@@_split_on_empty_lines_bool , split-on-empty-lines .default:n = true , split-separation .tl_set:N = \l_@@_split_separation_tl , split-separation .value_required:n = true , marker .code:n = \bool_lazy_or:nnTF \l_@@_in_PitonInputFile_bool \l_@@_in_PitonOptions_bool { \keys_set:nn { PitonOptions / marker } { #1 } } { \@@_error:n { Invalid~key } } , marker .value_required:n = true , line-numbers .code:n = \keys_set:nn { PitonOptions / line-numbers } { #1 } , line-numbers .default:n = true , splittable .int_set:N = \l_@@_splittable_int , splittable .default:n = 1 , background-color .clist_set:N = \l_@@_bg_color_clist , background-color .value_required:n = true , prompt-background-color .tl_set:N = \l_@@_prompt_bg_color_tl , prompt-background-color .value_required:n = true , width .code:n = \str_if_eq:nnTF { #1 } { min } { \bool_set_true:N \l_@@_width_min_bool \dim_zero:N \l_@@_width_dim } { \bool_set_false:N \l_@@_width_min_bool \dim_set:Nn \l_@@_width_dim { #1 } } , width .value_required:n = true , write .str_set:N = \l_@@_write_str , write .value_required:n = true , left-margin .code:n = \str_if_eq:nnTF { #1 } { auto } { \dim_zero:N \l_@@_left_margin_dim \bool_set_true:N \l_@@_left_margin_auto_bool } { \dim_set:Nn \l_@@_left_margin_dim { #1 } \bool_set_false:N \l_@@_left_margin_auto_bool } , left-margin .value_required:n = true , tab-size .int_set:N = \l_@@_tab_size_int , tab-size .value_required:n = true , show-spaces .bool_set:N = \l_@@_show_spaces_bool , show-spaces .value_forbidden:n = true , show-spaces-in-strings .code:n = \tl_set:Nn \l_@@_space_in_string_tl { ␣ } , % U+2423 show-spaces-in-strings .value_forbidden:n = true , break-lines-in-Piton .bool_set:N = \l_@@_break_lines_in_Piton_bool , break-lines-in-Piton .default:n = true , break-lines-in-piton .bool_set:N = \l_@@_break_lines_in_piton_bool , break-lines-in-piton .default:n = true , break-lines .meta:n = { break-lines-in-piton , break-lines-in-Piton } , break-lines .value_forbidden:n = true , indent-broken-lines .bool_set:N = \l_@@_indent_broken_lines_bool , indent-broken-lines .default:n = true , end-of-broken-line .tl_set:N = \l_@@_end_of_broken_line_tl , end-of-broken-line .value_required:n = true , continuation-symbol .tl_set:N = \l_@@_continuation_symbol_tl , continuation-symbol .value_required:n = true , continuation-symbol-on-indentation .tl_set:N = \l_@@_csoi_tl , continuation-symbol-on-indentation .value_required:n = true , first-line .code:n = \@@_in_PitonInputFile:n { \int_set:Nn \l_@@_first_line_int { #1 } } , first-line .value_required:n = true , last-line .code:n = \@@_in_PitonInputFile:n { \int_set:Nn \l_@@_last_line_int { #1 } } , last-line .value_required:n = true , begin-range .code:n = \@@_in_PitonInputFile:n { \str_set:Nn \l_@@_begin_range_str { #1 } } , begin-range .value_required:n = true , end-range .code:n = \@@_in_PitonInputFile:n { \str_set:Nn \l_@@_end_range_str { #1 } } , end-range .value_required:n = true , range .code:n = \@@_in_PitonInputFile:n { \str_set:Nn \l_@@_begin_range_str { #1 } \str_set:Nn \l_@@_end_range_str { #1 } } , range .value_required:n = true , env-used-by-split .code:n = \lua_now:n { piton.env_used_by_split = '#1' } , env-used-by-split .initial:n = Piton , resume .meta:n = line-numbers/resume , unknown .code:n = \@@_error:n { Unknown~key~for~PitonOptions } , % deprecated all-line-numbers .code:n = \bool_set_true:N \l_@@_line_numbers_bool \bool_set_false:N \l_@@_skip_empty_lines_bool , all-line-numbers .value_forbidden:n = true } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_in_PitonInputFile:n #1 { \bool_if:NTF \l_@@_in_PitonInputFile_bool { #1 } { \@@_error:n { Invalid~key } } } % \end{macrocode} % % % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} \NewDocumentCommand \PitonOptions { m } { \bool_set_true:N \l_@@_in_PitonOptions_bool \keys_set:nn { PitonOptions } { #1 } \bool_set_false:N \l_@@_in_PitonOptions_bool } % \end{macrocode} % % % % \bigskip % When using |\NewPitonEnvironment| a user may use |\PitonOptions| inside. % However, the set of keys available should be different that in standard % |\PitonOptions|. That's why we define a version of |\PitonOptions| with no % restriction on the set of available keys and we will link that version to % |\PitonOptions| in such environment. % \begin{macrocode} \NewDocumentCommand \@@_fake_PitonOptions { } { \keys_set:nn { PitonOptions } } % \end{macrocode} % % % % % \bigskip % \subsubsection{The numbers of the lines} % % \medskip % The following counter will be used to count the lines in the code when the % user requires the numbers of the lines to be printed (with |line-numbers|) % whereas the counter |\g_@@_line_int| previously defined is \emph{not} used for % that functionality. % % \begin{macrocode} \int_new:N \g_@@_visual_line_int % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_incr_visual_line: { \bool_if:NF \l_@@_skip_empty_lines_bool { \int_gincr:N \g_@@_visual_line_int } } % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_print_number: { \hbox_overlap_left:n { { \l_@@_line_numbers_format_tl % \end{macrocode} % We put braces. Thus, the user may use the key |line-numbers/format| with a % value such as |\fbox|. % \begin{macrocode} { \int_to_arabic:n \g_@@_visual_line_int } } \skip_horizontal:N \l_@@_numbers_sep_dim } } % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % \subsubsection{The command to write on the aux file} % % % \begin{macrocode} \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_write_aux: { \tl_if_empty:NF \g_@@_aux_tl { \iow_now:Nn \@mainaux { \ExplSyntaxOn } \iow_now:Ne \@mainaux { \tl_gset:cn { c_@@_ \int_use:N \g_@@_env_int _ tl } { \exp_not:o \g_@@_aux_tl } } \iow_now:Nn \@mainaux { \ExplSyntaxOff } } \tl_gclear:N \g_@@_aux_tl } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % The following macro with be used only when the key |width| is used with the % special value~|min|. % \begin{macrocode} \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_width_to_aux: { \tl_gput_right:Ne \g_@@_aux_tl { \dim_set:Nn \l_@@_line_width_dim { \dim_eval:n { \g_@@_tmp_width_dim } } } } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \subsubsection{The main commands and environments for the final user} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} \NewDocumentCommand { \NewPitonLanguage } { O { } m ! o } { \tl_if_novalue:nTF { #3 } % \end{macrocode} % The last argument is provided by curryfication. % \begin{macrocode} { \@@_NewPitonLanguage:nnn { #1 } { #2 } } % \end{macrocode} % The two last arguments are provided by curryfication. % \begin{macrocode} { \@@_NewPitonLanguage:nnnnn { #1 } { #2 } { #3 } } } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % The following property list will contain the definitions of the informatic % languages as provided by the final user. However, if a language is defined % over another base language, the corresponding list will contain the \emph{whole} % definition of the language. % \begin{macrocode} \prop_new:N \g_@@_languages_prop % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} \keys_define:nn { NewPitonLanguage } { morekeywords .code:n = , otherkeywords .code:n = , sensitive .code:n = , keywordsprefix .code:n = , moretexcs .code:n = , morestring .code:n = , morecomment .code:n = , moredelim .code:n = , moredirectives .code:n = , tag .code:n = , alsodigit .code:n = , alsoletter .code:n = , alsoother .code:n = , unknown .code:n = \@@_error:n { Unknown~key~NewPitonLanguage } } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % The function |\@@_NewPitonLanguage:nnn| will be used when the language is % \emph{not} defined above a base language (and a base dialect). % \begin{macrocode} \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_NewPitonLanguage:nnn #1 #2 #3 { % \end{macrocode} % We store in |\l_tmpa_tl| the name of the language with the potential dialect, % that is to say, for example : |[AspectJ]{Java}|. We use |\tl_if_blank:nF| % because the final user may have written |\NewPitonLanguage[ ]{Java}{...}|. % \begin{macrocode} \tl_set:Ne \l_tmpa_tl { \tl_if_blank:nF { #1 } { [ \str_lowercase:n { #1 } ] } \str_lowercase:n { #2 } } % \end{macrocode} % % The following set of keys is only used to raise an error when a key in unknown! % \begin{macrocode} \keys_set:nn { NewPitonLanguage } { #3 } % \end{macrocode} % % We store in LaTeX the definition of the language because some languages may be % defined with that language as base language. % \begin{macrocode} \prop_gput:Non \g_@@_languages_prop \l_tmpa_tl { #3 } % \end{macrocode} % The Lua part of the package \pkg{piton} will be loaded in a % |\AtBeginDocument|. Hence, we will put also in a |\AtBeginDocument| the % utilisation of the Lua function |piton.new_language| (which does the main job). % \begin{macrocode} \@@_NewPitonLanguage:on \l_tmpa_tl { #3 } } % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} \cs_generate_variant:Nn \@@_NewPitonLanguage:nn { o } \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_NewPitonLanguage:nn #1 #2 { \hook_gput_code:nnn { begindocument } { . } { \lua_now:e { piton.new_language("#1","\lua_escape:n{#2}") } } } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % Now the case when the language is defined upon a base language. % \begin{macrocode} \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_NewPitonLanguage:nnnnn #1 #2 #3 #4 #5 { % \end{macrocode} % We store in |\l_tmpa_tl| the name of the base language with the dialect, that % is to say, for example : |[AspectJ]{Java}|. We use |\tl_if_blank:nF| because % the final user may have used |\NewPitonLanguage[Handel]{C}[ ]{C}{...}| % \begin{macrocode} \tl_set:Ne \l_tmpa_tl { \tl_if_blank:nF { #3 } { [ \str_lowercase:n { #3 } ] } \str_lowercase:n { #4 } } % \end{macrocode} % We retrieve in |\l_tmpb_tl| the definition (as provided by the final user) of % that base language. Caution: |\g_@@_languages_prop| does not contain all the % languages provided by \pkg{piton} but only those defined by using % |\NewPitonLanguage|. % \begin{macrocode} \prop_get:NoNTF \g_@@_languages_prop \l_tmpa_tl \l_tmpb_tl % \end{macrocode} % We can now define the new language by using the previous function. % \begin{macrocode} { \@@_NewPitonLanguage:nnno { #1 } { #2 } { #5 } \l_tmpb_tl } { \@@_error:n { Language~not~defined } } } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} \cs_generate_variant:Nn \@@_NewPitonLanguage:nnnn { n n n o } \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_NewPitonLanguage:nnnn #1 #2 #3 #4 % \end{macrocode} % In the following line, we write |#4,#3| and not |#3,#4| because we want that the % keys which correspond to base language appear before the keys which are added % in the language we define. % \begin{macrocode} { \@@_NewPitonLanguage:nnn { #1 } { #2 } { #4 , #3 } } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} \NewDocumentCommand { \piton } { } { \peek_meaning:NTF \bgroup \@@_piton_standard \@@_piton_verbatim } % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} \NewDocumentCommand { \@@_piton_standard } { m } { \group_begin: \bool_lazy_or:nnT \l_@@_break_lines_in_piton_bool % \end{macrocode} % We have to deal with the case of |break-strings-anywhere| because, % otherwise, the |\nobreakspace| would result in a sequence of TeX instructions % and we would have difficulities during the insertion of all the commands |\-| % (to allow breaks anywhere in the string). % \begin{macrocode} \l_@@_break_strings_anywhere_bool { \tl_set_eq:NN \l_@@_space_in_string_tl \space } % \end{macrocode} % The following tuning of LuaTeX in order to avoid all breaks of lines on the % hyphens. % \begin{macrocode} \automatichyphenmode = 1 % \end{macrocode} % Remark that the argument of |\piton| (with the normal syntax) is expanded in % the TeX sens, (see the |\tl_set:Ne| below) and that's why we can provide the % following escapes to the final user: % \begin{macrocode} \cs_set_eq:NN \\ \c_backslash_str \cs_set_eq:NN \% \c_percent_str \cs_set_eq:NN \{ \c_left_brace_str \cs_set_eq:NN \} \c_right_brace_str \cs_set_eq:NN \$ \c_dollar_str % \end{macrocode} % The standard command |\␣| is \emph{not} expandable and we need here expandable % commands. With the following code, we define an expandable command. % \begin{macrocode} \cs_set_eq:cN { ~ } \space % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} \cs_set_eq:NN \@@_begin_line: \prg_do_nothing: \tl_set:Ne \l_tmpa_tl { \lua_now:e { piton.ParseBis('\l_piton_language_str',token.scan_string()) } { #1 } } \bool_if:NTF \l_@@_show_spaces_bool { \regex_replace_all:nnN { \x20 } { ␣ } \l_tmpa_tl } % U+2423 % \end{macrocode} % The following code replaces the characters U+0020 (spaces) by characters % U+0020 of catcode~10: thus, they become breakable by an end of line. Maybe, % this programmation is not very efficient but the key |break-lines-in-piton| % will be rarely used. % \begin{macrocode} { \bool_if:NT \l_@@_break_lines_in_piton_bool { \regex_replace_all:nnN { \x20 } { \x20 } \l_tmpa_tl } } % \end{macrocode} % The command |\text| is provided by the package \pkg{amstext} (loaded by \pkg{piton}). % \begin{macrocode} \if_mode_math: \text { \l_@@_font_command_tl \l_tmpa_tl } \else: \l_@@_font_command_tl \l_tmpa_tl \fi: \group_end: } % \end{macrocode} % % % \begin{macrocode} \NewDocumentCommand { \@@_piton_verbatim } { v } { \group_begin: \automatichyphenmode = 1 \cs_set_eq:NN \@@_begin_line: \prg_do_nothing: \tl_set:Ne \l_tmpa_tl { \lua_now:e { piton.Parse('\l_piton_language_str',token.scan_string()) } { #1 } } \bool_if:NT \l_@@_show_spaces_bool { \regex_replace_all:nnN { \x20 } { ␣ } \l_tmpa_tl } % U+2423 \if_mode_math: \text { \l_@@_font_command_tl \l_tmpa_tl } \else: \l_@@_font_command_tl \l_tmpa_tl \fi: \group_end: } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % % % \bigskip % The following command does \emph{not} correspond to a user command. It will % be used when we will have to ``rescan'' some chunks of informatic code. For % example, it will be the initial value of the Piton style |InitialValues| (the % default values of the arguments of a Python function). % \begin{macrocode} \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_piton:n #1 { \tl_if_blank:nF { #1 } { \@@_piton_i:n { #1 } } } \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_piton_i:n #1 { \group_begin: \cs_set_eq:NN \@@_begin_line: \prg_do_nothing: \cs_set:cpn { pitonStyle _ \l_piton_language_str _ Prompt } { } \cs_set:cpn { pitonStyle _ Prompt } { } \cs_set_eq:NN \@@_trailing_space: \space \tl_set:Ne \l_tmpa_tl { \lua_now:e { piton.ParseTer('\l_piton_language_str',token.scan_string()) } { #1 } } \bool_if:NT \l_@@_show_spaces_bool { \regex_replace_all:nnN { \x20 } { ␣ } \l_tmpa_tl } % U+2423 \@@_replace_spaces:o \l_tmpa_tl \group_end: } % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % Despite its name, |\@@_pre_env:| will be used both in |\PitonInputFile| and % in the environments such as |{Piton}|. % \begin{macrocode} \cs_new:Npn \@@_pre_env: { \automatichyphenmode = 1 \int_gincr:N \g_@@_env_int \tl_gclear:N \g_@@_aux_tl \dim_compare:nNnT \l_@@_width_dim = \c_zero_dim { \dim_set_eq:NN \l_@@_width_dim \linewidth } % \end{macrocode} % We read the information written on the |aux| file by a previous run (when the % key |width| is used with the special value~|min|). At this time, the only % potential information written on the |aux| file is the value of % |\l_@@_line_width_dim| when the key |width| has been used with the special % value~|min|). % \begin{macrocode} \cs_if_exist_use:c { c_@@ _ \int_use:N \g_@@_env_int _ tl } \bool_if:NF \l_@@_resume_bool { \int_gzero:N \g_@@_visual_line_int } \dim_gzero:N \g_@@_tmp_width_dim \int_gzero:N \g_@@_line_int \dim_zero:N \parindent \dim_zero:N \lineskip \cs_set_eq:NN \label \@@_label:n } % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % If the final user has used both |left-margin=auto| and |line-numbers|, we have % to compute the width of the maximal number of lines at the end of the % environment to fix the correct value to |left-margin|. The first argument of % the following function is the name of the Lua function that will be applied to % the second argument in order to count the number of lines. % \begin{macrocode} \cs_generate_variant:Nn \@@_compute_left_margin:nn { n o } \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_compute_left_margin:nn #1 #2 { \bool_lazy_and:nnT \l_@@_left_margin_auto_bool \l_@@_line_numbers_bool { \hbox_set:Nn \l_tmpa_box { \l_@@_line_numbers_format_tl \bool_if:NTF \l_@@_skip_empty_lines_bool { \lua_now:n { piton.#1(token.scan_argument()) } { #2 } \int_to_arabic:n { \g_@@_visual_line_int + \l_@@_nb_non_empty_lines_int } } { \int_to_arabic:n { \g_@@_visual_line_int + \l_@@_nb_lines_int } } } \dim_set:Nn \l_@@_left_margin_dim { \box_wd:N \l_tmpa_box + \l_@@_numbers_sep_dim + 0.1 em } } } % \end{macrocode} % % % % \bigskip % Whereas |\l_@@_with_dim| is the width of the environment, % |\l_@@_line_width_dim| is the width of the lines of code without the % potential margins for the numbers of lines and the background. Depending on % the case, you have to compute |\l_@@_line_width_dim| from |\l_@@_width_dim| or % we have to do the opposite. % \begin{macrocode} \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_compute_width: { \dim_compare:nNnTF \l_@@_line_width_dim = \c_zero_dim { \dim_set_eq:NN \l_@@_line_width_dim \l_@@_width_dim \clist_if_empty:NTF \l_@@_bg_color_clist % \end{macrocode} % If there is no background, we only subtract the left margin. % \begin{macrocode} { \dim_sub:Nn \l_@@_line_width_dim \l_@@_left_margin_dim } % \end{macrocode} % If there is a background, we subtract 0.5~em for the margin on the right. % \begin{macrocode} { \dim_sub:Nn \l_@@_line_width_dim { 0.5 em } % \end{macrocode} % And we subtract also for the left margin. If the key |left-margin| has been % used (with a numerical value or with the special value~|min|), % |\l_@@_left_margin_dim| has a non-zero value\footnote{If the key % \texttt{left-margin} has been used with the special value \texttt{min}, the % actual value of \texttt{\textbackslash l_\@\@_left_margin_dim} has yet been % computed when we use the current command.} and we use that value. Elsewhere, % we use a value of 0.5~em. % \begin{macrocode} \dim_compare:nNnTF \l_@@_left_margin_dim = \c_zero_dim { \dim_sub:Nn \l_@@_line_width_dim { 0.5 em } } { \dim_sub:Nn \l_@@_line_width_dim \l_@@_left_margin_dim } } } % \end{macrocode} % If |\l_@@_line_width_dim| has yet a non-zero value, that means that it has % been read in the |aux| file: it has been written by a previous run because the % key |width| is used with the special value~|min|). We compute now the width of % the environment by computations opposite to the preceding ones. % \begin{macrocode} { \dim_set_eq:NN \l_@@_width_dim \l_@@_line_width_dim \clist_if_empty:NTF \l_@@_bg_color_clist { \dim_add:Nn \l_@@_width_dim \l_@@_left_margin_dim } { \dim_add:Nn \l_@@_width_dim { 0.5 em } \dim_compare:nNnTF \l_@@_left_margin_dim = \c_zero_dim { \dim_add:Nn \l_@@_width_dim { 0.5 em } } { \dim_add:Nn \l_@@_width_dim \l_@@_left_margin_dim } } } } % \end{macrocode} % % % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} \NewDocumentCommand { \NewPitonEnvironment } { m m m m } { % \end{macrocode} % We construct a TeX macro which will catch as argument all the tokens until % |\end{|\texttt{\textsl{name_env}}|}| with, in that % |\end{|\texttt{\textsl{name_env}}|}|, the catcodes of |\|, |{| and |}| equal to % 12 (``\texttt{other}''). The latter explains why the definition of that % function is a bit complicated. % \begin{macrocode} \use:x { \cs_set_protected:Npn \use:c { _@@_collect_ #1 :w } ####1 \c_backslash_str end \c_left_brace_str #1 \c_right_brace_str } { \group_end: % \end{macrocode} % Maybe, we should deactivate all the ``shorthands'' of \pkg{babel} (when % \pkg{babel} is loaded) with the following instruction: % % \verb|\IfPackageLoadedT { babel } { \languageshorthands { none } }| % % But we should be sure that there is no consequence in the LaTeX comments... % \begin{macrocode} \mode_if_vertical:TF \noindent \newline % \end{macrocode} % The following line is only to compute |\l_@@_lines_int| which will be used % only when both |left-margin=auto| and |skip-empty-lines = false| are in force. % We should change that. % \begin{macrocode} \lua_now:e { piton.CountLines ( '\lua_escape:n{##1}' ) } % \end{macrocode} % The first argument of the following function is the name of the Lua function % that will be applied to the second argument in order to count the number of lines. % \begin{macrocode} \@@_compute_left_margin:nn { CountNonEmptyLines } { ##1 } \@@_compute_width: \l_@@_font_command_tl \dim_zero:N \parskip \noindent % \end{macrocode} % % Now, the key |write|. % \begin{macrocode} \str_if_empty:NTF \l_@@_path_write_str { \lua_now:e { piton.write = "\l_@@_write_str" } } { \lua_now:e { piton.write = "\l_@@_path_write_str / \l_@@_write_str" } } \str_if_empty:NTF \l_@@_write_str { \lua_now:n { piton.write = '' } } { \seq_if_in:NoTF \g_@@_write_seq \l_@@_write_str { \lua_now:n { piton.write_mode = "a" } } { \lua_now:n { piton.write_mode = "w" } \seq_gput_left:No \g_@@_write_seq \l_@@_write_str } } % \end{macrocode} % \bigskip % Now, the main job. % \begin{macrocode} \bool_if:NTF \l_@@_split_on_empty_lines_bool \@@_retrieve_gobble_split_parse:n \@@_retrieve_gobble_parse:n { ##1 } % \end{macrocode} % % If the user has used the key |width| with the special value~|min|, we write on % the |aux| file the value of |\l_@@_line_width_dim| (largest width of the lines % of code of the environment). % \begin{macrocode} \bool_if:NT \l_@@_width_min_bool \@@_width_to_aux: % \end{macrocode} % The following |\end{#1}| is only for the stack of environments of LaTeX. % \begin{macrocode} \end { #1 } \@@_write_aux: } % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % We can now define the new environment. % % We are still in the definition of the command |\NewPitonEnvironment|... % \begin{macrocode} \NewDocumentEnvironment { #1 } { #2 } { \cs_set_eq:NN \PitonOptions \@@_fake_PitonOptions #3 \@@_pre_env: \int_compare:nNnT \l_@@_number_lines_start_int > \c_zero_int { \int_gset:Nn \g_@@_visual_line_int { \l_@@_number_lines_start_int - 1 } } \group_begin: \tl_map_function:nN { \ \\ \{ \} \$ \& \# \^ \_ \% \~ \^^I } \char_set_catcode_other:N \use:c { _@@_collect_ #1 :w } } { #4 } % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % The following code is for technical reasons. We want to change the catcode of % |^^M| before catching the arguments of the new environment we are defining. % Indeed, if not, we will have problems if there is a final optional argument in % our environment (if that final argument is not used by the user in an % instance of the environment, a spurious space is inserted, probably because % the |^^M| is converted to space). % \begin{macrocode} \AddToHook { env / #1 / begin } { \char_set_catcode_other:N \^^M } } % \end{macrocode} % This is the end of the definition of the command |\NewPitonEnvironment|. % % \bigskip % The following function will be used when the key |split-on-empty-lines| is not % in force. It will retrieve the first empty line, gobble the spaces at the % beginning of the lines and parse the code. The argument is provided by % curryfication. % \begin{macrocode} \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_retrieve_gobble_parse:n { \lua_now:e { piton.RetrieveGobbleParse ( '\l_piton_language_str' , \int_use:N \l_@@_gobble_int , \bool_if:NTF \l_@@_splittable_on_empty_lines_bool { \int_eval:n { - \l_@@_splittable_int } } { \int_use:N \l_@@_splittable_int } , token.scan_argument ( ) ) } } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % The following function will be used when the key |split-on-empty-lines| is in % force. It will gobble the spaces at the beginning of the lines (if the key % |gobble| is in force), then split the code at the empty lines and, eventually, % parse the code. The argument is provided by curryfication. % \begin{macrocode} \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_retrieve_gobble_split_parse:n { \lua_now:e { piton.RetrieveGobbleSplitParse ( '\l_piton_language_str' , \int_use:N \l_@@_gobble_int , \int_use:N \l_@@_splittable_int , token.scan_argument ( ) ) } } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % Now, we define the environment |{Piton}|, which is the main environment % provided by the package \pkg{piton}. Of course, you use % |\NewPitonEnvironment|. % \begin{macrocode} \bool_if:NTF \g_@@_beamer_bool { \NewPitonEnvironment { Piton } { d < > O { } } { \keys_set:nn { PitonOptions } { #2 } \tl_if_novalue:nTF { #1 } { \begin { uncoverenv } } { \begin { uncoverenv } < #1 > } } { \end { uncoverenv } } } { \NewPitonEnvironment { Piton } { O { } } { \keys_set:nn { PitonOptions } { #1 } } { } } % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % The code of the command |\PitonInputFile| is somewhat similar to the code of % the environment |{Piton}|. In fact, it's simpler because there isn't the % problem of catching the content of the environment in a verbatim mode. % \begin{macrocode} \NewDocumentCommand { \PitonInputFileTF } { d < > O { } m m m } { \group_begin: % \end{macrocode} % In version 4.0 of \pkg{piton}, we changed the mechanism used by \pkg{piton} % to search the file to load with |\PitonInputFile|. With the key % |old-PitonInputFile|, it's possible to keep the old behaviour but it's only % for backward compatibility and it will be deleted in a future version. % \begin{macrocode} \bool_if:NTF \l_@@_old_PitonInputFile_bool { \bool_set_false:N \l_tmpa_bool \seq_map_inline:Nn \l__piton_path_seq { \str_set:Nn \l__piton_file_name_str { ##1 / #3 } \file_if_exist:nT { \l__piton_file_name_str } { \__piton_input_file:nn { #1 } { #2 } \bool_set_true:N \l_tmpa_bool \seq_map_break: } } \bool_if:NTF \l_tmpa_bool { #4 } { #5 } } { \seq_concat:NNN \l_file_search_path_seq \l_@@_path_seq \l_file_search_path_seq \file_get_full_name:nNTF { #3 } \l_@@_file_name_str { \@@_input_file:nn { #1 } { #2 } #4 } { #5 } } \group_end: } % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % \begin{macrocode} \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_unknown_file:n #1 { \msg_error:nnn { piton } { Unknown~file } { #1 } } % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} \NewDocumentCommand { \PitonInputFile } { d < > O { } m } { \PitonInputFileTF < #1 > [ #2 ] { #3 } { } { \@@_unknown_file:n { #3 } } } \NewDocumentCommand { \PitonInputFileT } { d < > O { } m m } { \PitonInputFileTF < #1 > [ #2 ] { #3 } { #4 } { \@@_unknown_file:n { #3 } } } \NewDocumentCommand { \PitonInputFileF } { d < > O { } m m } { \PitonInputFileTF < #1 > [ #2 ] { #3 } { } { #4 } } % \end{macrocode} % % The following command uses as implicit argument the name of the file in % |\l_@@_file_name_str|. % \begin{macrocode} \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_input_file:nn #1 #2 { % \end{macrocode} % We recall that, if we are in Beamer, the command |\PitonInputFile| is % ``overlay-aware'' and that's why there is an optional argument between angular % brackets (|<| and |>|). % \begin{macrocode} \tl_if_novalue:nF { #1 } { \bool_if:NTF \g_@@_beamer_bool { \begin { uncoverenv } < #1 > } { \@@_error_or_warning:n { overlay~without~beamer } } } \group_begin: \int_zero_new:N \l_@@_first_line_int \int_zero_new:N \l_@@_last_line_int \int_set_eq:NN \l_@@_last_line_int \c_max_int \bool_set_true:N \l_@@_in_PitonInputFile_bool \keys_set:nn { PitonOptions } { #2 } \bool_if:NT \l_@@_line_numbers_absolute_bool { \bool_set_false:N \l_@@_skip_empty_lines_bool } \bool_if:nTF { ( \int_compare_p:nNn \l_@@_first_line_int > \c_zero_int || \int_compare_p:nNn \l_@@_last_line_int < \c_max_int ) && ! \str_if_empty_p:N \l_@@_begin_range_str } { \@@_error_or_warning:n { bad~range~specification } \int_zero:N \l_@@_first_line_int \int_set_eq:NN \l_@@_last_line_int \c_max_int } { \str_if_empty:NF \l_@@_begin_range_str { \@@_compute_range: \bool_lazy_or:nnT \l_@@_marker_include_lines_bool { ! \str_if_eq_p:NN \l_@@_begin_range_str \l_@@_end_range_str } { \int_decr:N \l_@@_first_line_int \int_incr:N \l_@@_last_line_int } } } \@@_pre_env: \bool_if:NT \l_@@_line_numbers_absolute_bool { \int_gset:Nn \g_@@_visual_line_int { \l_@@_first_line_int - 1 } } \int_compare:nNnT \l_@@_number_lines_start_int > \c_zero_int { \int_gset:Nn \g_@@_visual_line_int { \l_@@_number_lines_start_int - 1 } } % \end{macrocode} % The following case arises when the code |line-numbers/absolute| is in force % without the use of a marked range. % \begin{macrocode} \int_compare:nNnT \g_@@_visual_line_int < \c_zero_int { \int_gzero:N \g_@@_visual_line_int } \mode_if_vertical:TF \mode_leave_vertical: \newline % \end{macrocode} % We count with Lua the number of lines of the argument. The result will be % stored by Lua in |\l_@@_nb_lines_int|. % \begin{macrocode} \lua_now:e { piton.CountLinesFile ( '\l_@@_file_name_str' ) } % \end{macrocode} % The first argument of the following function is the name of the Lua function % that will be applied to the second argument in order to count the number of lines. % \begin{macrocode} \@@_compute_left_margin:no { CountNonEmptyLinesFile } \l_@@_file_name_str \@@_compute_width: \l_@@_font_command_tl \lua_now:e { piton.ParseFile( '\l_piton_language_str' , '\l_@@_file_name_str' , \int_use:N \l_@@_first_line_int , \int_use:N \l_@@_last_line_int , \bool_if:NTF \l_@@_splittable_on_empty_lines_bool { \int_eval:n { - \l_@@_splittable_int } } { \int_use:N \l_@@_splittable_int } , \bool_if:NTF \l_@@_split_on_empty_lines_bool { 1 } { 0 } ) } \bool_if:NT \l_@@_width_min_bool \@@_width_to_aux: \group_end: % \end{macrocode} % % % The following line is to allow programs such as |latexmk| to be aware that the % file (read by |\PitonInputFile|) is loaded during the compilation of the LaTeX % document. % \begin{macrocode} \iow_log:e {(\l_@@_file_name_str)} % \end{macrocode} % We recall that, if we are in Beamer, the command |\PitonInputFile| is % ``overlay-aware'' and that's why we close now an environment |{uncoverenv}| % that we have opened at the beginning of the command. % \begin{macrocode} \tl_if_novalue:nF { #1 } { \bool_if:NT \g_@@_beamer_bool { \end { uncoverenv } } } \@@_write_aux: } % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % The following command computes the values of |\l_@@_first_line_int| and % |\l_@@_last_line_int| when |\PitonInputFile| is used with textual markers. % \begin{macrocode} \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_compute_range: { % \end{macrocode} % We store the markers in L3 strings (|str|) in order to do safely the following % replacement of |\#|. % \begin{macrocode} \str_set:Ne \l_tmpa_str { \@@_marker_beginning:n \l_@@_begin_range_str } \str_set:Ne \l_tmpb_str { \@@_marker_end:n \l_@@_end_range_str } % \end{macrocode} % We replace the sequences |\#| which may be present in the prefixes (and, more % unlikely, suffixes) added to the markers by the functions % |\@@_marker_beginning:n| and |\@@_marker_end:n| % \begin{macrocode} \regex_replace_all:nVN { \\\# } \c_hash_str \l_tmpa_str \regex_replace_all:nVN { \\\# } \c_hash_str \l_tmpb_str % \end{macrocode} % However, it seems that our programmation is not good programmation because % our |\l_tmpa_str| is not a valid |str| value (maybe we should correct that). % \begin{macrocode} \lua_now:e { piton.ComputeRange ( '\l_tmpa_str' , '\l_tmpb_str' , '\l_@@_file_name_str' ) } } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \subsubsection{The styles} % % \medskip % The following command is fundamental: it will be used by the Lua code. % \begin{macrocode} \NewDocumentCommand { \PitonStyle } { m } { \cs_if_exist_use:cF { pitonStyle _ \l_piton_language_str _ #1 } { \use:c { pitonStyle _ #1 } } } % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % \begin{macrocode} \NewDocumentCommand { \SetPitonStyle } { O { } m } { \str_clear_new:N \l_@@_SetPitonStyle_option_str \str_set:Ne \l_@@_SetPitonStyle_option_str { \str_lowercase:n { #1 } } \str_if_eq:onT \l_@@_SetPitonStyle_option_str { current-language } { \str_set_eq:NN \l_@@_SetPitonStyle_option_str \l_piton_language_str } \keys_set:nn { piton / Styles } { #2 } } % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % \begin{macrocode} \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_math_scantokens:n #1 { \normalfont \scantextokens { \begin{math} #1 \end{math} } } % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % \begin{macrocode} \clist_new:N \g_@@_styles_clist \clist_gset:Nn \g_@@_styles_clist { Comment , Comment.LaTeX , Discard , Exception , FormattingType , Identifier.Internal , Identifier , InitialValues , Interpol.Inside , Keyword , Keyword.Governing , Keyword.Constant , Keyword2 , Keyword3 , Keyword4 , Keyword5 , Keyword6 , Keyword7 , Keyword8 , Keyword9 , Name.Builtin , Name.Class , Name.Constructor , Name.Decorator , Name.Field , Name.Function , Name.Module , Name.Namespace , Name.Table , Name.Type , Number , Number.Internal , Operator , Operator.Word , Preproc , Prompt , String.Doc , String.Interpol , String.Long , String.Long.Internal , String.Short , String.Short.Internal , Tag , TypeParameter , UserFunction , % \end{macrocode} % |TypeExpression| is an internal style for expressions which defines types in OCaml. % \begin{macrocode} TypeExpression , % \end{macrocode} % Now, specific styles for the languages created with |\NewPitonLanguage| with % the syntax of \pkg{listings}. % \begin{macrocode} Directive } \clist_map_inline:Nn \g_@@_styles_clist { \keys_define:nn { piton / Styles } { #1 .value_required:n = true , #1 .code:n = \tl_set:cn { pitonStyle _ \str_if_empty:NF \l_@@_SetPitonStyle_option_str { \l_@@_SetPitonStyle_option_str _ } #1 } { ##1 } } } \keys_define:nn { piton / Styles } { String .meta:n = { String.Long = #1 , String.Short = #1 } , Comment.Math .tl_set:c = pitonStyle _ Comment.Math , unknown .code:n = \@@_error:n { Unknown~key~for~SetPitonStyle } } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} \SetPitonStyle[OCaml] { TypeExpression = \SetPitonStyle { Identifier = \PitonStyle { Name.Type } } \@@_piton:n , } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % We add the word |String| to the list of the styles because we will use that % list in the error message for an unknown key in |\SetPitonStyle|. % % \begin{macrocode} \clist_gput_left:Nn \g_@@_styles_clist { String } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % Of course, we sort that clist. % \begin{macrocode} \clist_gsort:Nn \g_@@_styles_clist { \str_compare:nNnTF { #1 } < { #2 } \sort_return_same: \sort_return_swapped: } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} % \bool_new:N \l_@@_break_strings_anywhere_bool \cs_set_eq:NN \@@_break_strings_anywhere:n \prg_do_nothing: \cs_set_eq:NN \@@_break_numbers_anywhere:n \prg_do_nothing: \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_actually_break_anywhere:n #1 { \tl_set:Nn \l_tmpa_tl { #1 } % \end{macrocode} % We have to begin by a substitution for the spaces. Otherwise, they would be % gobbled in the |\tl_map_inline:Nn|. % \begin{macrocode} \regex_replace_all:nnN { \x20 } { \c { space } } \l_tmpa_tl \tl_map_inline:Nn \l_tmpa_tl { \seq_put_right:Nn \l_tmpa_seq { ##1 } } \seq_use:Nn \l_tmpa_seq { \- } } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_string_long:n #1 { \PitonStyle { String.Long } { \bool_if:NT \l_@@_break_strings_anywhere_bool { \@@_actually_break_anywhere:n } { #1 } } } \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_string_short:n #1 { \PitonStyle { String.Short } { \bool_if:NT \l_@@_break_strings_anywhere_bool { \@@_actually_break_anywhere:n } { #1 } } } \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_number:n #1 { \PitonStyle { Number } { \bool_if:NT \l_@@_break_numbers_anywhere_bool { \@@_actually_break_anywhere:n } { #1 } } } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \subsubsection{The initial styles} % % The initial styles are inspired by the style ``manni'' of Pygments. % % \medskip % \begin{macrocode} \SetPitonStyle { Comment = \color[HTML]{0099FF} \itshape , Exception = \color[HTML]{CC0000} , Keyword = \color[HTML]{006699} \bfseries , Keyword.Governing = \color[HTML]{006699} \bfseries , Keyword.Constant = \color[HTML]{006699} \bfseries , Name.Builtin = \color[HTML]{336666} , Name.Decorator = \color[HTML]{9999FF}, Name.Class = \color[HTML]{00AA88} \bfseries , Name.Function = \color[HTML]{CC00FF} , Name.Namespace = \color[HTML]{00CCFF} , Name.Constructor = \color[HTML]{006000} \bfseries , Name.Field = \color[HTML]{AA6600} , Name.Module = \color[HTML]{0060A0} \bfseries , Name.Table = \color[HTML]{309030} , Number = \color[HTML]{FF6600} , Number.Internal = \@@_number:n , Operator = \color[HTML]{555555} , Operator.Word = \bfseries , String = \color[HTML]{CC3300} , String.Long.Internal = \@@_string_long:n , String.Short.Internal = \@@_string_short:n , String.Doc = \color[HTML]{CC3300} \itshape , String.Interpol = \color[HTML]{AA0000} , Comment.LaTeX = \normalfont \color[rgb]{.468,.532,.6} , Name.Type = \color[HTML]{336666} , InitialValues = \@@_piton:n , Interpol.Inside = \l_@@_font_command_tl \@@_piton:n , TypeParameter = \color[HTML]{336666} \itshape , Preproc = \color[HTML]{AA6600} \slshape , % \end{macrocode} % We need the command |\@@_identifier:n| because of the command % |\SetPitonIdentifier|. The command |\@@_identifier:n| will potentially call % the style |Identifier| (which is a user-style, not an internal style). % \begin{macrocode} Identifier.Internal = \@@_identifier:n , Identifier = , Directive = \color[HTML]{AA6600} , Tag = \colorbox{gray!10}, UserFunction = \PitonStyle{Identifier} , Prompt = , Discard = \use_none:n } % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % If the key |math-comments| has been used in the preamble of the LaTeX % document, we change the style |Comment.Math| which should be considered only % at an ``internal style''. However, maybe we will document in a future version % the possibility to write change the style \emph{locally} in a document)]. % \begin{macrocode} \hook_gput_code:nnn { begindocument } { . } { \bool_if:NT \g_@@_math_comments_bool { \SetPitonStyle { Comment.Math = \@@_math_scantokens:n } } } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % % \bigskip % \subsubsection{Highlighting some identifiers} % % % \medskip % \begin{macrocode} \NewDocumentCommand { \SetPitonIdentifier } { o m m } { \clist_set:Nn \l_tmpa_clist { #2 } \tl_if_novalue:nTF { #1 } { \clist_map_inline:Nn \l_tmpa_clist { \cs_set:cpn { PitonIdentifier _ ##1 } { #3 } } } { \str_set:Ne \l_tmpa_str { \str_lowercase:n { #1 } } \str_if_eq:onT \l_tmpa_str { current-language } { \str_set_eq:NN \l_tmpa_str \l_piton_language_str } \clist_map_inline:Nn \l_tmpa_clist { \cs_set:cpn { PitonIdentifier _ \l_tmpa_str _ ##1 } { #3 } } } } % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_identifier:n #1 { \cs_if_exist_use:cF { PitonIdentifier _ \l_piton_language_str _ #1 } { \cs_if_exist_use:cF { PitonIdentifier _ #1 } { \PitonStyle { Identifier } } } { #1 } } % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % In particular, we have an highlighting of the identifiers which are the % names of Python functions previously defined by the user. Indeed, when a % Python function is defined, the style |Name.Function.Internal| is applied to % that name. We define now that style (you define it directly and you short-cut % the function |\SetPitonStyle|). % \begin{macrocode} \cs_new_protected:cpn { pitonStyle _ Name.Function.Internal } #1 { % \end{macrocode} % First, the element is composed in the TeX flow with the style |Name.Function| % which is provided to the final user. % \begin{macrocode} { \PitonStyle { Name.Function } { #1 } } % \end{macrocode} % Now, we specify that the name of the new Python function is a known identifier % that will be formatted with the Piton style |UserFunction|. Of course, % here the affectation is global because we have to exit many groups and even % the environments |{Piton}|). % \begin{macrocode} \cs_gset_protected:cpn { PitonIdentifier _ \l_piton_language_str _ #1 } { \PitonStyle { UserFunction } } % \end{macrocode} % Now, we put the name of that new user function in the dedicated sequence % (specific of the current language). {\bfseries That sequence will be used only % by |\PitonClearUserFunctions|}. % \begin{macrocode} \seq_if_exist:cF { g_@@_functions _ \l_piton_language_str _ seq } { \seq_new:c { g_@@_functions _ \l_piton_language_str _ seq } } \seq_gput_right:cn { g_@@_functions _ \l_piton_language_str _ seq } { #1 } % \end{macrocode} % We update |\g_@@_languages_seq| which is used only by the command % |\PitonClearUserFunctions| when it's used without its optional argument. % \begin{macrocode} \seq_if_in:NoF \g_@@_languages_seq \l_piton_language_str { \seq_gput_left:No \g_@@_languages_seq \l_piton_language_str } } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} \NewDocumentCommand \PitonClearUserFunctions { ! o } { \tl_if_novalue:nTF { #1 } % \end{macrocode} % If the command is used without its optional argument, we will deleted the % user language for all the informatic languages. % \begin{macrocode} { \@@_clear_all_functions: } { \@@_clear_list_functions:n { #1 } } } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_clear_list_functions:n #1 { \clist_set:Nn \l_tmpa_clist { #1 } \clist_map_function:NN \l_tmpa_clist \@@_clear_functions_i:n \clist_map_inline:nn { #1 } { \seq_gremove_all:Nn \g_@@_languages_seq { ##1 } } } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_clear_functions_i:n #1 { \@@_clear_functions_ii:n { \str_lowercase:n { #1 } } } % \end{macrocode} % % The following command clears the list of the user-defined functions for the % language provided in argument (mandatory in lower case). % \begin{macrocode} \cs_generate_variant:Nn \@@_clear_functions_ii:n { e } \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_clear_functions_ii:n #1 { \seq_if_exist:cT { g_@@_functions _ #1 _ seq } { \seq_map_inline:cn { g_@@_functions _ #1 _ seq } { \cs_undefine:c { PitonIdentifier _ #1 _ ##1} } \seq_gclear:c { g_@@_functions _ #1 _ seq } } } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_clear_functions:n #1 { \@@_clear_functions_i:n { #1 } \seq_gremove_all:Nn \g_@@_languages_seq { #1 } } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % The following command clears all the user-defined functions for all the % informatic languages. % \begin{macrocode} \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_clear_all_functions: { \seq_map_function:NN \g_@@_languages_seq \@@_clear_functions_i:n \seq_gclear:N \g_@@_languages_seq } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \subsubsection{Security} % % \begin{macrocode} \AddToHook { env / piton / begin } { \@@_fatal:n { No~environment~piton } } \msg_new:nnn { piton } { No~environment~piton } { There~is~no~environment~piton!\\ There~is~an~environment~{Piton}~and~a~command~ \token_to_str:N \piton\ but~there~is~no~environment~ {piton}.~This~error~is~fatal. } % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % \subsubsection{The error messages of the package} % % % \begin{macrocode} \@@_msg_new:nn { Language~not~defined } { Language~not~defined \\ The~language~'\l_tmpa_tl'~has~not~been~defined~previously.\\ If~you~go~on,~your~command~\token_to_str:N \NewPitonLanguage\ will~be~ignored. } % \end{macrocode} % % % \begin{macrocode} \@@_msg_new:nn { bad~version~of~piton.lua } { Bad~number~version~of~'piton.lua'\\ The~file~'piton.lua'~loaded~has~not~the~same~number~of~ version~as~the~file~'piton.sty'.~You~can~go~on~but~you~should~ address~that~issue. } % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} \@@_msg_new:nn { Unknown~key~NewPitonLanguage } { Unknown~key~for~\token_to_str:N \NewPitonLanguage.\\ The~key~'\l_keys_key_str'~is~unknown.\\ This~key~will~be~ignored.\\ } % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} \@@_msg_new:nn { Unknown~key~for~SetPitonStyle } { The~style~'\l_keys_key_str'~is~unknown.\\ This~key~will~be~ignored.\\ The~available~styles~are~(in~alphabetic~order):~ \clist_use:Nnnn \g_@@_styles_clist { ~and~ } { ,~ } { ~and~ }. } % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} \@@_msg_new:nn { Invalid~key } { Wrong~use~of~key.\\ You~can't~use~the~key~'\l_keys_key_str'~here.\\ That~key~will~be~ignored. } % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} \@@_msg_new:nn { Unknown~key~for~line-numbers } { Unknown~key. \\ The~key~'line-numbers / \l_keys_key_str'~is~unknown.\\ The~available~keys~of~the~family~'line-numbers'~are~(in~ alphabetic~order):~ absolute,~false,~label-empty-lines,~resume,~skip-empty-lines,~ sep,~start~and~true.\\ That~key~will~be~ignored. } % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} \@@_msg_new:nn { Unknown~key~for~marker } { Unknown~key. \\ The~key~'marker / \l_keys_key_str'~is~unknown.\\ The~available~keys~of~the~family~'marker'~are~(in~ alphabetic~order):~ beginning,~end~and~include-lines.\\ That~key~will~be~ignored. } % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} \@@_msg_new:nn { bad~range~specification } { Incompatible~keys.\\ You~can't~specify~the~range~of~lines~to~include~by~using~both~ markers~and~explicit~number~of~lines.\\ Your~whole~file~'\l_@@_file_name_str'~will~be~included. } % \end{macrocode} % % We don't give the name |syntax error| for the following error because you % should not give a name with a space because such space could be replaced by % U+2423 when the key |show-spaces| is in force in the command |\piton|. % \begin{macrocode} \@@_msg_new:nn { SyntaxError } { Syntax~Error.\\ Your~code~of~the~language~'\l_piton_language_str'~is~not~ syntactically~correct.\\ It~won't~be~printed~in~the~PDF~file. } % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} \@@_msg_new:nn { FileError } { File~Error.\\ It's~not~possible~to~write~on~the~file~'\l_@@_write_str'.\\ \sys_if_shell_unrestricted:F { Be~sure~to~compile~with~'-shell-escape'.\\ } If~you~go~on,~nothing~will~be~written~on~the~file. } % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} \@@_msg_new:nn { begin~marker~not~found } { Marker~not~found.\\ The~range~'\l_@@_begin_range_str'~provided~to~the~ command~\token_to_str:N \PitonInputFile\ has~not~been~found.~ The~whole~file~'\l_@@_file_name_str'~will~be~inserted. } % \end{macrocode} % % % \begin{macrocode} \@@_msg_new:nn { end~marker~not~found } { Marker~not~found.\\ The~marker~of~end~of~the~range~'\l_@@_end_range_str'~ provided~to~the~command~\token_to_str:N \PitonInputFile\ has~not~been~found.~The~file~'\l_@@_file_name_str'~will~ be~inserted~till~the~end. } % \end{macrocode} % % % \begin{macrocode} \@@_msg_new:nn { Unknown~file } { Unknown~file. \\ The~file~'#1'~is~unknown.\\ Your~command~\token_to_str:N \PitonInputFile\ will~be~discarded. } % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} \@@_msg_new:nnn { Unknown~key~for~PitonOptions } { Unknown~key. \\ The~key~'\l_keys_key_str'~is~unknown~for~\token_to_str:N \PitonOptions.~ It~will~be~ignored.\\ For~a~list~of~the~available~keys,~type~H~. } { The~available~keys~are~(in~alphabetic~order):~ auto-gobble,~ background-color,~ begin-range,~ break-lines,~ break-lines-in-piton,~ break-lines-in-Piton,~ break-numbers-anywhere,~ break-strings-anywhere,~ continuation-symbol,~ continuation-symbol-on-indentation,~ detected-beamer-commands,~ detected-beamer-environments,~ detected-commands,~ end-of-broken-line,~ end-range,~ env-gobble,~ env-used-by-split,~ font-command,~ gobble,~ indent-broken-lines,~ language,~ left-margin,~ line-numbers/,~ marker/,~ math-comments,~ path,~ path-write,~ prompt-background-color,~ resume,~ show-spaces,~ show-spaces-in-strings,~ splittable,~ splittable-on-empty-lines,~ split-on-empty-lines,~ split-separation,~ tabs-auto-gobble,~ tab-size,~ width~and~write. } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} \@@_msg_new:nn { label~with~lines~numbers } { You~can't~use~the~command~\token_to_str:N \label\ because~the~key~'line-numbers'~is~not~active.\\ If~you~go~on,~that~command~will~ignored. } % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} \@@_msg_new:nn { overlay~without~beamer } { You~can't~use~an~argument~<...>~for~your~command~ \token_to_str:N \PitonInputFile\ because~you~are~not~ in~Beamer.\\ If~you~go~on,~that~argument~will~be~ignored. } % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % \subsubsection{We load piton.lua} % % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} \cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_test_version:n #1 { \str_if_eq:onF \PitonFileVersion { #1 } { \@@_error:n { bad~version~of~piton.lua } } } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} \hook_gput_code:nnn { begindocument } { . } { \lua_now:n { require ( "piton" ) tex.sprint ( luatexbase.catcodetables.CatcodeTableExpl , "\\@@_test_version:n {" .. piton_version .. "}" ) } } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \subsubsection{Detected commands} % % % \begin{macrocode} \ExplSyntaxOff \begin{luacode*} lpeg.locale(lpeg) local P , alpha , C , space , S , V = lpeg.P , lpeg.alpha , lpeg.C , lpeg.space , lpeg.S , lpeg.V local add function add(...) local s = P ( false ) for _ , x in ipairs({...}) do s = s + x end return s end local my_lpeg = P { "E" , E = ( V "F" * ( "," * V "F" ) ^ 0 ) / add , % \end{macrocode} % Be careful: in Lua, \verb|/| has no priority over \verb|*|. Of course, we want % a behaviour for this comma-separated list equal to the behaviour of a |clist| % of L3. % \begin{macrocode} F = space ^ 0 * ( ( alpha ^ 1 ) / "\\%0" ) * space ^ 0 } function piton.addDetectedCommands ( key_value ) piton.DetectedCommands = piton.DetectedCommands + my_lpeg : match ( key_value ) end function piton.addBeamerCommands( key_value ) piton.BeamerCommands = piton.BeamerCommands + my_lpeg : match ( key_value ) end % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} local insert function insert(...) local s = piton.beamer_environments for _ , x in ipairs({...}) do table.insert(s,x) end return s end local my_lpeg_bis = P { "E" , E = ( V "F" * ( "," * V "F" ) ^ 0 ) / insert , F = space ^ 0 * ( alpha ^ 1 ) * space ^ 0 } function piton.addBeamerEnvironments( key_value ) piton.beamer_environments = my_lpeg_bis : match ( key_value ) end \end{luacode*} % % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % \subsection{The Lua part of the implementation} % % \bigskip % The Lua code will be loaded via a |{luacode*}| environment. The environment % is by itself a Lua block and the local declarations will be local to that % block. All the global functions (used by the L3 parts of the implementation) % will be put in a Lua table |piton|. % % % \begin{macrocode} %<*LUA> piton.comment_latex = piton.comment_latex or ">" piton.comment_latex = "#" .. piton.comment_latex % \end{macrocode} % % % \begin{macrocode} local sprintL3 function sprintL3 ( s ) tex.sprint ( luatexbase.catcodetables.expl , s ) end % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \subsubsection{Special functions dealing with LPEG} % % \medskip % We will use the Lua library \pkg{lpeg} which is built in LuaTeX. That's why we % define first aliases for several functions of that library. % \begin{macrocode} local P, S, V, C, Ct, Cc = lpeg.P, lpeg.S, lpeg.V, lpeg.C, lpeg.Ct, lpeg.Cc local Cs , Cg , Cmt , Cb = lpeg.Cs, lpeg.Cg , lpeg.Cmt , lpeg.Cb local B , R = lpeg.B , lpeg.R % \end{macrocode} % % % % \bigskip % The function |Q| takes in as argument a pattern and returns a \textsc{lpeg} % \emph{which does a capture} of the pattern. That capture will be sent to LaTeX % with the catcode ``other'' for all the characters: it's suitable for elements % of the informatic listings that \pkg{piton} will typeset verbatim (thanks to the % catcode ``other''). % \begin{macrocode} local Q function Q ( pattern ) return Ct ( Cc ( luatexbase.catcodetables.CatcodeTableOther ) * C ( pattern ) ) end % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % The function |L| takes in as argument a pattern and returns a \textsc{lpeg} % \emph{which does a capture} of the pattern. That capture will be sent to LaTeX % with standard LaTeX catcodes for all the characters: the elements captured % will be formatted as normal LaTeX codes. It's suitable for the ``LaTeX % comments'' in the environments |{Piton}| and the elements between % |begin-escape| and |end-escape|. That function won't be much used. % \begin{macrocode} local L function L ( pattern ) return Ct ( C ( pattern ) ) end % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % The function |Lc| (the c is for \emph{constant}) takes in as argument a string % and returns a \textsc{lpeg} \emph{with does a constant capture} which returns % that string. The elements captured will be formatted as L3 code. It will be % used to send to LaTeX all the formatting LaTeX instructions we have to insert % in order to do the syntactic highlighting (that's the main job of % \pkg{piton}). That function, unlike the previous one, will be widely used. % \begin{macrocode} local Lc function Lc ( string ) return Cc ( { luatexbase.catcodetables.expl , string } ) end % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % The function |K| creates a \textsc{lpeg} which will return as capture the % whole LaTeX code corresponding to a Python chunk (that is to say with the % LaTeX formatting instructions corresponding to the syntactic nature of that % Python chunk). The first argument is a Lua string corresponding to the name of % a \pkg{piton} style and the second element is a pattern (that is to say a % \textsc{lpeg} without capture) % \begin{macrocode}e local K function K ( style , pattern ) return Lc ( [[ {\PitonStyle{ ]] .. style .. "}{" ) * Q ( pattern ) * Lc "}}" end % \end{macrocode} % The formatting commands in a given \pkg{piton} style (eg. the style |Keyword|) % may be semi-global declarations (such as |\bfseries| or |\slshape|) or LaTeX % macros with an argument (such as |\fbox| or |\colorbox{yellow}|). In order to % deal with both syntaxes, we have used two pairs of braces: % |{\PitonStyle{Keyword}{|\texttt{\slshape text to format}|}}|. % % % \bigskip % The following function |WithStyle| is similar to the function |K| but should % be used for multi-lines elements. % \begin{macrocode} local WithStyle function WithStyle ( style , pattern ) return Ct ( Cc "Open" * Cc ( [[{\PitonStyle{]] .. style .. "}{" ) * Cc "}}" ) * pattern * Ct ( Cc "Close" ) end % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % The following \textsc{lpeg} catches the Python chunks which are in LaTeX % escapes (and that chunks will be considered as normal LaTeX constructions). % \begin{macrocode} Escape = P ( false ) EscapeClean = P ( false ) if piton.begin_escape then Escape = P ( piton.begin_escape ) * L ( ( 1 - P ( piton.end_escape ) ) ^ 1 ) * P ( piton.end_escape ) % \end{macrocode} % The LPEG |EscapeClean| will be used in the LPEG Clean (and that LPEG is used % to ``clean'' the code by removing the formatting elements). % \begin{macrocode} EscapeClean = P ( piton.begin_escape ) * ( 1 - P ( piton.end_escape ) ) ^ 1 * P ( piton.end_escape ) end % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} EscapeMath = P ( false ) if piton.begin_escape_math then EscapeMath = P ( piton.begin_escape_math ) * Lc "$" * L ( ( 1 - P(piton.end_escape_math) ) ^ 1 ) * Lc "$" * P ( piton.end_escape_math ) end % \end{macrocode} % % \vspace{1cm} % The following line is mandatory. % \begin{macrocode} lpeg.locale(lpeg) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \paragraph{The basic syntactic LPEG} % % \begin{macrocode} local alpha , digit = lpeg.alpha , lpeg.digit local space = P " " % \end{macrocode} % % Remember that, for \textsc{lpeg}, the Unicode characters such as |à|, |â|, % |ç|, etc. are in fact strings of length 2 (2 bytes) because \pkg{lpeg} is not % Unicode-aware. % \begin{macrocode} local letter = alpha + "_" + "â" + "à" + "ç" + "é" + "è" + "ê" + "ë" + "ï" + "î" + "ô" + "û" + "ü" + "Â" + "À" + "Ç" + "É" + "È" + "Ê" + "Ë" + "Ï" + "Î" + "Ô" + "Û" + "Ü" local alphanum = letter + digit % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % The following \textsc{lpeg} |identifier| is a mere pattern (that is to say % more or less a regular expression) which matches the Python identifiers (hence % the name). % \begin{macrocode} local identifier = letter * alphanum ^ 0 % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % On the other hand, the \textsc{lpeg} |Identifier| (with a capital) also returns % a \emph{capture}. % \begin{macrocode} local Identifier = K ( 'Identifier.Internal' , identifier ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % By convention, we will use names with an initial capital for \textsc{lpeg} % which return captures. % % % \bigskip % Here is the first use of our function~|K|. That function will be used to % construct \textsc{lpeg} which capture Python chunks for which we have a % dedicated \pkg{piton} style. For example, for the numbers, \pkg{piton} % provides a style which is called |Number|. The name of the style is provided % as a Lua string in the second argument of the function~|K|. By convention, we % use single quotes for delimiting the Lua strings which are names of % \pkg{piton} styles (but this is only a convention). % \begin{macrocode} local Number = K ( 'Number.Internal' , ( digit ^ 1 * P "." * # ( 1 - P "." ) * digit ^ 0 + digit ^ 0 * P "." * digit ^ 1 + digit ^ 1 ) * ( S "eE" * S "+-" ^ -1 * digit ^ 1 ) ^ -1 + digit ^ 1 ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % We will now define the LPEG |Word|. % % We have a problem in the following LPEG because, obviously, we should adjust % the list of symbols with the delimiters of the current language (no?). % \begin{macrocode} local lpeg_central = 1 - S " '\"\r[({})]" - digit % \end{macrocode} % We recall that |piton.begin_escape| and |piton_end_escape| are Lua strings % corresponding to the keys |begin-escape| and |end-escape|. % \begin{macrocode} if piton.begin_escape then lpeg_central = lpeg_central - piton.begin_escape end if piton.begin_escape_math then lpeg_central = lpeg_central - piton.begin_escape_math end local Word = Q ( lpeg_central ^ 1 ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} local Space = Q " " ^ 1 local SkipSpace = Q " " ^ 0 local Punct = Q ( S ".,:;!" ) local Tab = "\t" * Lc [[ \@@_tab: ]] % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % Remember that |\@@_leading_space:| does \emph{not} create a space, only an % incrementation of the counter |\g_@@_indentation_int|. % \begin{macrocode} local SpaceIndentation = Lc [[ \@@_leading_space: ]] * Q " " % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} local Delim = Q ( S "[({})]" ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % The following \textsc{lpeg} catches a space (U+0020) and replace it by % |\l_@@_space_in_string_tl|. It will be used in the strings. Usually, % |\l_@@_space_in_string_tl| will contain a space and therefore there won't be % difference. However, when the key |show-spaces-in-strings| is in force, % |\\l_@@_space_in_string_tl| will contain ␣ (U+2423) in order to visualize the % spaces. % \begin{macrocode} local SpaceInString = space * Lc [[ \l_@@_space_in_string_tl ]] % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \paragraph{Several tools for the construction of the main LPEG} % % \begin{macrocode} local LPEG0 = { } local LPEG1 = { } local LPEG2 = { } local LPEG_cleaner = { } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % For each language, we will need a pattern to match expressions with balanced % braces. Those balanced braces must \emph{not} take into account the braces % present in strings of the language. However, the syntax for the strings is % language-dependent. That's why we write a Lua function |Compute_braces| which % will compute the pattern by taking in as argument a pattern for the strings of % the language (at least the shorts strings). The argument of |Compute_braces| % must be a pattern \emph{which does no catching}. % \begin{macrocode} local Compute_braces function Compute_braces ( lpeg_string ) return P { "E" , E = ( "{" * V "E" * "}" + lpeg_string + ( 1 - S "{}" ) ) ^ 0 } end % \end{macrocode} % % % % \bigskip % The following Lua function will compute the \text{lpeg} |DetectedCommands| % which is a \textsc{lpeg} with captures. % \begin{macrocode} local Compute_DetectedCommands function Compute_DetectedCommands ( lang , braces ) return Ct ( Cc "Open" * C ( piton.DetectedCommands * space ^ 0 * P "{" ) * Cc "}" ) * ( braces / ( function ( s ) if s ~= '' then return LPEG1[lang] : match ( s ) end end ) ) * P "}" * Ct ( Cc "Close" ) end % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} local Compute_LPEG_cleaner function Compute_LPEG_cleaner ( lang , braces ) return Ct ( ( piton.DetectedCommands * "{" * ( braces / ( function ( s ) if s ~= '' then return LPEG_cleaner[lang] : match ( s ) end end ) ) * "}" + EscapeClean + C ( P ( 1 ) ) ) ^ 0 ) / table.concat end % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % The following function |ParseAgain| will be used in the definitions of the % LPEG of the different informatic languages when we will need to % \emph{parse again} a small chunk of code. It's a way to avoid the use of a actual % \emph{grammar} of LPEG (in a sens, a recursive regular expression). % % Remark that there is no \pkg{piton} style associated to a chunk of code which % is analyzed by |ParseAgain|. If we wish a \pkg{piton} style available to the % final user (if he wish to format that element with a uniform font instead of % an analyze by |ParseAgain|), we have to use |\@@_piton:n|. % \begin{macrocode} local ParseAgain function ParseAgain ( code ) if code ~= '' then return % \end{macrocode} % The variable |piton.language| is set in the function |piton.Parse|. % \begin{macrocode} LPEG1[piton.language] : match ( code ) end end % \end{macrocode} % % % % \bigskip % \paragraph{Constructions for Beamer} % % \bigskip % If the class Beamer is used, some environments and commands of Beamer are % automatically detected in the listings of \pkg{piton}. % \begin{macrocode} local Beamer = P ( false ) local BeamerBeginEnvironments = P ( true ) local BeamerEndEnvironments = P ( true ) % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} piton.BeamerEnvironments = P ( false ) for _ , x in ipairs ( piton.beamer_environments ) do piton.BeamerEnvironments = piton.BeamerEnvironments + x end % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} BeamerBeginEnvironments = ( space ^ 0 * L ( P [[\begin{]] * piton.BeamerEnvironments * "}" * ( "<" * ( 1 - P ">" ) ^ 0 * ">" ) ^ -1 ) * "\r" ) ^ 0 % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} BeamerEndEnvironments = ( space ^ 0 * L ( P [[\end{]] * piton.BeamerEnvironments * "}" ) * "\r" ) ^ 0 % \end{macrocode} % % % % \bigskip % The following Lua function will be used to compute the \textsc{lpeg} |Beamer| % for each informatic language. % \begin{macrocode} local Compute_Beamer function Compute_Beamer ( lang , braces ) % \end{macrocode} % % \smallskip % We will compute in |lpeg| the \textsc{lpeg} that we will return. % \begin{macrocode} local lpeg = L ( P [[\pause]] * ( "[" * ( 1 - P "]" ) ^ 0 * "]" ) ^ -1 ) lpeg = lpeg + Ct ( Cc "Open" * C ( piton.BeamerCommands * ( "<" * ( 1 - P ">" ) ^ 0 * ">" ) ^ -1 * P "{" ) * Cc "}" ) * ( braces / ( function ( s ) if s ~= '' then return LPEG1[lang] : match ( s ) end end ) ) * "}" * Ct ( Cc "Close" ) % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % For the command |\alt|, the specification of the overlays (between angular % brackets) is mandatory. % \begin{macrocode} lpeg = lpeg + L ( P [[\alt]] * "<" * ( 1 - P ">" ) ^ 0 * ">{" ) * ( braces / ( function ( s ) if s ~= '' then return LPEG1[lang] : match ( s ) end end ) ) * L ( P "}{" ) * ( braces / ( function ( s ) if s ~= '' then return LPEG1[lang] : match ( s ) end end ) ) * L ( P "}" ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % For |\temporal|, the specification of the overlays (between angular brackets) % is mandatory. % \begin{macrocode} lpeg = lpeg + L ( P [[\temporal]] * "<" * ( 1 - P ">" ) ^ 0 * ">{" ) * ( braces / ( function ( s ) if s ~= '' then return LPEG1[lang] : match ( s ) end end ) ) * L ( P "}{" ) * ( braces / ( function ( s ) if s ~= '' then return LPEG1[lang] : match ( s ) end end ) ) * L ( P "}{" ) * ( braces / ( function ( s ) if s ~= '' then return LPEG1[lang] : match ( s ) end end ) ) * L ( P "}" ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % Now, the environments of Beamer. % \begin{macrocode} for _ , x in ipairs ( piton.beamer_environments ) do lpeg = lpeg + Ct ( Cc "Open" * C ( P ( [[\begin{]] .. x .. "}" ) * ( "<" * ( 1 - P ">") ^ 0 * ">" ) ^ -1 ) * Cc ( [[\end{]] .. x .. "}" ) ) * ( ( ( 1 - P ( [[\end{]] .. x .. "}" ) ) ^ 0 ) / ( function ( s ) if s ~= '' then return LPEG1[lang] : match ( s ) end end ) ) * P ( [[\end{]] .. x .. "}" ) * Ct ( Cc "Close" ) end % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % Now, you can return the value we have computed. % \begin{macrocode} return lpeg end % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % The following LPEG is in relation with the key |math-comments|. It will be % used in all the languages. % \begin{macrocode} local CommentMath = P "$" * K ( 'Comment.Math' , ( 1 - S "$\r" ) ^ 1 ) * P "$" -- $ % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % \paragraph{EOL} % % \bigskip % The following LPEG will detect the Python prompts when the user is typesetting % an interactive session of Python (directly or through |{pyconsole}| of % \pkg{pyluatex}). We have to detect that prompt twice. The first detection % (called \emph{hasty detection}) will be before the |\@@_begin_line:| because % you want to trigger a special background color for that row (and, after the % |\@@_begin_line:|, it's too late to change de background). % \begin{macrocode} local PromptHastyDetection = ( # ( P ">>>" + "..." ) * Lc [[ \@@_prompt: ]] ) ^ -1 % \end{macrocode} % We remind that the marker |#| of \textsc{lpeg} specifies that the pattern will be % detected but won't consume any character. % % \medskip % With the following \textsc{lpeg}, a style will actually be applied to the % prompt (for instance, it's possible to decide to discard these prompts). % \begin{macrocode} local Prompt = K ( 'Prompt' , ( ( P ">>>" + "..." ) * P " " ^ -1 ) ) ^ -1 % \end{macrocode} % % % % \bigskip % The following \textsc{lpeg} |EOL| is for the end of lines. % \begin{macrocode} local EOL = P "\r" * ( space ^ 0 * -1 + % \end{macrocode} % We recall that each line of the informatic code we have to parse will be sent % back to LaTeX between a pair |\@@_begin_line:| -- % |\@@_end_line:|\footnote{Remember that the \texttt{\textbackslash % @@\_end\_line:} must be explicit because it will be used as marker in order to % delimit the argument of the command \texttt{\textbackslash @@\_begin\_line:}}. % \begin{macrocode} Ct ( Cc "EOL" * Ct ( Lc [[ \@@_end_line: ]] * BeamerEndEnvironments * ( % \end{macrocode} % If the last line of the listing is the end of an environment of Beamer (eg. % |\end{uncoverenv}|), then, we don't open a new line. A token |\@@_end_line:| % will be added at the end of the environment but it will be no-op since we have % defined the macro |\@@_end_line:| to be no-op (even though it is also used as % a marker for the TeX delimited macro |\@@_begin_line:|). % \begin{macrocode} -1 + BeamerBeginEnvironments * PromptHastyDetection * Lc [[ \@@_newline:\@@_begin_line: ]] * Prompt ) ) ) ) * ( SpaceIndentation ^ 0 * # ( 1 - S " \r" ) ) ^ -1 % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % The following \textsc{lpeg} |CommentLaTeX| is for what is called in that % document the ``LaTeX comments''. Since the elements that will be caught must % be sent to LaTeX with standard LaTeX catcodes, we put the capture (done by % the function~|C|) in a table (by using~|Ct|, which is an alias for |lpeg.Ct|). % \begin{macrocode} local CommentLaTeX = P ( piton.comment_latex ) * Lc [[{\PitonStyle{Comment.LaTeX}{\ignorespaces]] * L ( ( 1 - P "\r" ) ^ 0 ) * Lc "}}" * ( EOL + -1 ) % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % \subsubsection{The language Python} % % We open a Lua local scope for the language Python (of course, there will be % also global definitions). % \begin{macrocode} do % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % Some strings of length 2 are explicit because we want the corresponding % ligatures available in some fonts such as \emph{Fira Code} to be active. % \begin{macrocode} local Operator = K ( 'Operator' , P "!=" + "<>" + "==" + "<<" + ">>" + "<=" + ">=" + ":=" + "//" + "**" + S "-~+/*%=<>&.@|" ) local OperatorWord = K ( 'Operator.Word' , P "in" + "is" + "and" + "or" + "not" ) % \end{macrocode} % % \smallskip % The keyword |in| in a construction such as ``|for i in range(n)|'' must be % formatted as a keyword and not as an |Operator.Word| and that's why we write % the following LPEG |For|. % \begin{macrocode} local For = K ( 'Keyword' , P "for" ) * Space * Identifier * Space * K ( 'Keyword' , P "in" ) local Keyword = K ( 'Keyword' , P "as" + "assert" + "break" + "case" + "class" + "continue" + "def" + "del" + "elif" + "else" + "except" + "exec" + "finally" + "for" + "from" + "global" + "if" + "import" + "lambda" + "non local" + "pass" + "return" + "try" + "while" + "with" + "yield" + "yield from" ) + K ( 'Keyword.Constant' , P "True" + "False" + "None" ) local Builtin = K ( 'Name.Builtin' , P "__import__" + "abs" + "all" + "any" + "bin" + "bool" + "bytearray" + "bytes" + "chr" + "classmethod" + "compile" + "complex" + "delattr" + "dict" + "dir" + "divmod" + "enumerate" + "eval" + "filter" + "float" + "format" + "frozenset" + "getattr" + "globals" + "hasattr" + "hash" + "hex" + "id" + "input" + "int" + "isinstance" + "issubclass" + "iter" + "len" + "list" + "locals" + "map" + "max" + "memoryview" + "min" + "next" + "object" + "oct" + "open" + "ord" + "pow" + "print" + "property" + "range" + "repr" + "reversed" + "round" + "set" + "setattr" + "slice" + "sorted" + "staticmethod" + "str" + "sum" + "super" + "tuple" + "type" + "vars" + "zip" ) local Exception = K ( 'Exception' , P "ArithmeticError" + "AssertionError" + "AttributeError" + "BaseException" + "BufferError" + "BytesWarning" + "DeprecationWarning" + "EOFError" + "EnvironmentError" + "Exception" + "FloatingPointError" + "FutureWarning" + "GeneratorExit" + "IOError" + "ImportError" + "ImportWarning" + "IndentationError" + "IndexError" + "KeyError" + "KeyboardInterrupt" + "LookupError" + "MemoryError" + "NameError" + "NotImplementedError" + "OSError" + "OverflowError" + "PendingDeprecationWarning" + "ReferenceError" + "ResourceWarning" + "RuntimeError" + "RuntimeWarning" + "StopIteration" + "SyntaxError" + "SyntaxWarning" + "SystemError" + "SystemExit" + "TabError" + "TypeError" + "UnboundLocalError" + "UnicodeDecodeError" + "UnicodeEncodeError" + "UnicodeError" + "UnicodeTranslateError" + "UnicodeWarning" + "UserWarning" + "ValueError" + "VMSError" + "Warning" + "WindowsError" + "ZeroDivisionError" + "BlockingIOError" + "ChildProcessError" + "ConnectionError" + "BrokenPipeError" + "ConnectionAbortedError" + "ConnectionRefusedError" + "ConnectionResetError" + "FileExistsError" + "FileNotFoundError" + "InterruptedError" + "IsADirectoryError" + "NotADirectoryError" + "PermissionError" + "ProcessLookupError" + "TimeoutError" + "StopAsyncIteration" + "ModuleNotFoundError" + "RecursionError" ) local RaiseException = K ( 'Keyword' , P "raise" ) * SkipSpace * Exception * Q "(" % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % In Python, a ``decorator'' is a statement whose begins by |@| which patches % the function defined in the following statement. % \begin{macrocode} local Decorator = K ( 'Name.Decorator' , P "@" * letter ^ 1 ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % The following \textsc{lpeg} |DefClass| will be used to detect the definition of a % new class (the name of that new class will be formatted with the \pkg{piton} % style |Name.Class|). % % \smallskip % Example:\enskip \piton{class myclass:} % \begin{macrocode} local DefClass = K ( 'Keyword' , "class" ) * Space * K ( 'Name.Class' , identifier ) % \end{macrocode} % % If the word |class| is not followed by a identifier, it will be caught as % keyword by the \textsc{lpeg} |Keyword| (useful if we want to type a % list of keywords). % % \bigskip % The following \textsc{lpeg} |ImportAs| is used for the lines beginning by |import|. % % We have to detect the potential keyword |as| because both the name of the % module and its alias must be formatted with the \pkg{piton} style |Name.Namespace|. % % \smallskip % Example:\enskip \piton{import numpy as np} % % \smallskip % Moreover, after the keyword |import|, it's possible to have a comma-separated % list of modules (if the keyword |as| is not used). % % \smallskip % Example:\enskip \piton{import math, numpy} % \begin{macrocode} local ImportAs = K ( 'Keyword' , "import" ) * Space * K ( 'Name.Namespace' , identifier * ( "." * identifier ) ^ 0 ) * ( ( Space * K ( 'Keyword' , "as" ) * Space * K ( 'Name.Namespace' , identifier ) ) + ( SkipSpace * Q "," * SkipSpace * K ( 'Name.Namespace' , identifier ) ) ^ 0 ) % \end{macrocode} % Be careful: there is no commutativity of |+| in the previous expression. % % \bigskip % The \textsc{lpeg} |FromImport| is used for the lines beginning by |from|. We % need a special treatment because the identifier following the keyword |from| % must be formatted with the \pkg{piton} style |Name.Namespace| and the % following keyword |import| must be formatted with the \pkg{piton} style % |Keyword| and must \emph{not} be caught by the \textsc{lpeg} |ImportAs|. % % \smallskip % Example:\enskip \piton{from math import pi} % % \smallskip % \begin{macrocode} local FromImport = K ( 'Keyword' , "from" ) * Space * K ( 'Name.Namespace' , identifier ) * Space * K ( 'Keyword' , "import" ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \paragraph{The strings of Python} % % For the strings in Python, there are four categories of delimiters (without % counting the prefixes for f-strings and raw strings). We will use, in the % names of our \textsc{lpeg}, prefixes to distinguish the \textsc{lpeg} dealing % with that categories of strings, as presented in the following tabular. % \begin{center} % \begin{tabular}{@{}lcc@{}} % \toprule % & |Single| & |Double| \\ % \midrule % |Short| & |'text'| & |"text"| \\ % |Long| & |'''test'''| & |"""text"""| \\ % \bottomrule % \end{tabular} % \end{center} % % % \bigskip % We have also to deal with the interpolations in the f-strings. Here % is an example of a f-string with an interpolation and a format % instruction\footnote{There is no special \pkg{piton} style for the formatting % instruction (after the colon): the style which will be applied will be the % style of the encompassing string, that is to say |String.Short| or % |String.Long|.} in that interpolation: % % |\piton{f'Total price: {total+1:.2f} €'}| % % % \bigskip % The interpolations beginning by |%| (even though there is more modern % techniques now in Python). % \begin{macrocode} local PercentInterpol = K ( 'String.Interpol' , P "%" * ( "(" * alphanum ^ 1 * ")" ) ^ -1 * ( S "-#0 +" ) ^ 0 * ( digit ^ 1 + "*" ) ^ -1 * ( "." * ( digit ^ 1 + "*" ) ) ^ -1 * ( S "HlL" ) ^ -1 * S "sdfFeExXorgiGauc%" ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % We can now define the \textsc{lpeg} for the four kinds of strings. It's not % possible to use our function~|K| because of the interpolations which must be % formatted with another \pkg{piton} style that the rest of the % string.\footnote{The interpolations are formatted with the \pkg{piton} style % |Interpol.Inside|. The initial value of that style is \texttt{\textbackslash % @@\_piton:n} which means that the interpolations are parsed once again by \pkg{piton}.} % \begin{macrocode} local SingleShortString = WithStyle ( 'String.Short.Internal' , % \end{macrocode} % First, we deal with the f-strings of Python, which are prefixed by |f| or |F|. % \begin{macrocode} Q ( P "f'" + "F'" ) * ( K ( 'String.Interpol' , "{" ) * K ( 'Interpol.Inside' , ( 1 - S "}':" ) ^ 0 ) * Q ( P ":" * ( 1 - S "}:'" ) ^ 0 ) ^ -1 * K ( 'String.Interpol' , "}" ) + SpaceInString + Q ( ( P "\\'" + "\\\\" + "{{" + "}}" + 1 - S " {}'" ) ^ 1 ) ) ^ 0 * Q "'" + % \end{macrocode} % Now, we deal with the standard strings of Python, but also the ``raw strings''. % \begin{macrocode} Q ( P "'" + "r'" + "R'" ) * ( Q ( ( P "\\'" + "\\\\" + 1 - S " '\r%" ) ^ 1 ) + SpaceInString + PercentInterpol + Q "%" ) ^ 0 * Q "'" ) % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} local DoubleShortString = WithStyle ( 'String.Short.Internal' , Q ( P "f\"" + "F\"" ) * ( K ( 'String.Interpol' , "{" ) * K ( 'Interpol.Inside' , ( 1 - S "}\":" ) ^ 0 ) * ( K ( 'String.Interpol' , ":" ) * Q ( (1 - S "}:\"") ^ 0 ) ) ^ -1 * K ( 'String.Interpol' , "}" ) + SpaceInString + Q ( ( P "\\\"" + "\\\\" + "{{" + "}}" + 1 - S " {}\"" ) ^ 1 ) ) ^ 0 * Q "\"" + Q ( P "\"" + "r\"" + "R\"" ) * ( Q ( ( P "\\\"" + "\\\\" + 1 - S " \"\r%" ) ^ 1 ) + SpaceInString + PercentInterpol + Q "%" ) ^ 0 * Q "\"" ) local ShortString = SingleShortString + DoubleShortString % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \paragraph{Beamer} % % The argument of |Compute_braces| must be a pattern \emph{which does no % catching} corresponding to the strings of the language. % % \begin{macrocode} local braces = Compute_braces ( ( P "\"" + "r\"" + "R\"" + "f\"" + "F\"" ) * ( P "\\\"" + 1 - S "\"" ) ^ 0 * "\"" + ( P '\'' + 'r\'' + 'R\'' + 'f\'' + 'F\'' ) * ( P '\\\'' + 1 - S '\'' ) ^ 0 * '\'' ) if piton.beamer then Beamer = Compute_Beamer ( 'python' , braces ) end % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \paragraph{Detected commands} % % \begin{macrocode} DetectedCommands = Compute_DetectedCommands ( 'python' , braces ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % % \paragraph{LPEG_cleaner} % % \begin{macrocode} LPEG_cleaner.python = Compute_LPEG_cleaner ( 'python' , braces ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \paragraph{The long strings} % % % \begin{macrocode} local SingleLongString = WithStyle ( 'String.Long.Internal' , ( Q ( S "fF" * P "'''" ) * ( K ( 'String.Interpol' , "{" ) * K ( 'Interpol.Inside' , ( 1 - S "}:\r" - "'''" ) ^ 0 ) * Q ( P ":" * (1 - S "}:\r" - "'''" ) ^ 0 ) ^ -1 * K ( 'String.Interpol' , "}" ) + Q ( ( 1 - P "'''" - S "{}'\r" ) ^ 1 ) + EOL ) ^ 0 + Q ( ( S "rR" ) ^ -1 * "'''" ) * ( Q ( ( 1 - P "'''" - S "\r%" ) ^ 1 ) + PercentInterpol + P "%" + EOL ) ^ 0 ) * Q "'''" ) % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} local DoubleLongString = WithStyle ( 'String.Long.Internal' , ( Q ( S "fF" * "\"\"\"" ) * ( K ( 'String.Interpol', "{" ) * K ( 'Interpol.Inside' , ( 1 - S "}:\r" - "\"\"\"" ) ^ 0 ) * Q ( ":" * (1 - S "}:\r" - "\"\"\"" ) ^ 0 ) ^ -1 * K ( 'String.Interpol' , "}" ) + Q ( ( 1 - S "{}\"\r" - "\"\"\"" ) ^ 1 ) + EOL ) ^ 0 + Q ( S "rR" ^ -1 * "\"\"\"" ) * ( Q ( ( 1 - P "\"\"\"" - S "%\r" ) ^ 1 ) + PercentInterpol + P "%" + EOL ) ^ 0 ) * Q "\"\"\"" ) % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} local LongString = SingleLongString + DoubleLongString % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % We have a \textsc{lpeg} for the Python docstrings. That \textsc{lpeg} will % be used in the \textsc{lpeg} |DefFunction| which deals with the whole preamble % of a function definition (which begins with |def|). % \begin{macrocode} local StringDoc = K ( 'String.Doc' , P "r" ^ -1 * "\"\"\"" ) * ( K ( 'String.Doc' , (1 - P "\"\"\"" - "\r" ) ^ 0 ) * EOL * Tab ^ 0 ) ^ 0 * K ( 'String.Doc' , ( 1 - P "\"\"\"" - "\r" ) ^ 0 * "\"\"\"" ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \paragraph{The comments in the Python listings} % % We define different \textsc{lpeg} dealing with comments in the Python % listings. % \begin{macrocode} local Comment = WithStyle ( 'Comment' , Q "#" * ( CommentMath + Q ( ( 1 - S "$\r" ) ^ 1 ) ) ^ 0 -- $ ) * ( EOL + -1 ) % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % \paragraph{DefFunction} % % The following \textsc{lpeg} |expression| will be used for the parameters in % the \emph{argspec} of a Python function. It's necessary to use a \emph{grammar} % because that pattern mainly checks the correct nesting of the delimiters % (and it's known in the theory of formal languages that this can't be done with % regular expressions \emph{stricto sensu} only). % \begin{macrocode} local expression = P { "E" , E = ( "'" * ( P "\\'" + 1 - S "'\r" ) ^ 0 * "'" + "\"" * ( P "\\\"" + 1 - S "\"\r" ) ^ 0 * "\"" + "{" * V "F" * "}" + "(" * V "F" * ")" + "[" * V "F" * "]" + ( 1 - S "{}()[]\r," ) ) ^ 0 , F = ( "{" * V "F" * "}" + "(" * V "F" * ")" + "[" * V "F" * "]" + ( 1 - S "{}()[]\r\"'" ) ) ^ 0 } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % We will now define a \textsc{lpeg} |Params| that will catch the list of % parameters (that is to say the \emph{argspec}) in the definition of a Python % function. For example, in the line of code % \begin{center} % \piton{def MyFunction(a,b,x=10,n:int): return n} % \end{center} % the \textsc{lpeg} |Params| will be used to catch the chunk\enskip |a,b,x=10,n:int|. % % \medskip % \begin{macrocode} local Params = P { "E" , E = ( V "F" * ( Q "," * V "F" ) ^ 0 ) ^ -1 , F = SkipSpace * ( Identifier + Q "*args" + Q "**kwargs" ) * SkipSpace * ( K ( 'InitialValues' , "=" * expression ) + Q ":" * SkipSpace * K ( 'Name.Type' , identifier ) ) ^ -1 } % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % The following \textsc{lpeg} |DefFunction| catches a keyword |def| and the % following name of function \emph{but also everything else until a potential % docstring}. That's why this definition of \textsc{lpeg} must occur (in the file % |piton.sty|) after the definition of several other \textsc{lpeg} such as % |Comment|, |CommentLaTeX|, |Params|, |StringDoc|... % \begin{macrocode} local DefFunction = K ( 'Keyword' , "def" ) * Space * K ( 'Name.Function.Internal' , identifier ) * SkipSpace * Q "(" * Params * Q ")" * SkipSpace * ( Q "->" * SkipSpace * K ( 'Name.Type' , identifier ) ) ^ -1 % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} * ( C ( ( 1 - S ":\r" ) ^ 0 ) / ParseAgain ) * Q ":" * ( SkipSpace * ( EOL + CommentLaTeX + Comment ) -- in all cases, that contains an EOL * Tab ^ 0 * SkipSpace * StringDoc ^ 0 -- there may be additional docstrings ) ^ -1 % \end{macrocode} % Remark that, in the previous code, |CommentLaTeX| \emph{must} appear % before |Comment|: there is no commutativity of the addition for the % \emph{parsing expression grammars} (\textsc{peg}). % % \smallskip % If the word |def| is not followed by an identifier and parenthesis, it will be % caught as keyword by the \textsc{lpeg} |Keyword| (useful if, for example, the % final user wants to speak of the keyword \piton{def}). % % % \paragraph{Miscellaneous} % % \begin{macrocode} local ExceptionInConsole = Exception * Q ( ( 1 - P "\r" ) ^ 0 ) * EOL % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % \paragraph{The main LPEG for the language Python} % % \begin{macrocode} local EndKeyword = Space + Punct + Delim + EOL + Beamer + DetectedCommands + Escape + EscapeMath + -1 % \end{macrocode} % % First, the main loop : % \begin{macrocode} local Main = space ^ 0 * EOL -- faut-il le mettre en commentaire ? + Space + Tab + Escape + EscapeMath + CommentLaTeX + Beamer + DetectedCommands + LongString + Comment + ExceptionInConsole + Delim + Operator + OperatorWord * EndKeyword + ShortString + Punct + FromImport + RaiseException + DefFunction + DefClass + For + Keyword * EndKeyword + Decorator + Builtin * EndKeyword + Identifier + Number + Word % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % Here, we must not put |local|, of course. % \begin{macrocode} LPEG1.python = Main ^ 0 % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % We recall that each line in the Python code to parse will be sent back to % LaTeX between a pair |\@@_begin_line:| -- |\@@_end_line:|\footnote{Remember % that the \texttt{\textbackslash @@\_end\_line:} must be explicit because it % will be used as marker in order to delimit the argument of the command % \texttt{\textbackslash @@\_begin\_line:}}. % \begin{macrocode} LPEG2.python = Ct ( ( space ^ 0 * "\r" ) ^ -1 * BeamerBeginEnvironments * PromptHastyDetection * Lc [[ \@@_begin_line: ]] * Prompt * SpaceIndentation ^ 0 * ( space ^ 1 * -1 + space ^ 0 * EOL + Main ) ^ 0 * -1 * Lc [[ \@@_end_line: ]] ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % End of the Lua scope for the language Python. % \begin{macrocode} end % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \subsubsection{The language Ocaml} % % We open a Lua local scope for the language OCaml (of course, there will be also % global definitions). % \begin{macrocode} do % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} local SkipSpace = ( Q " " + EOL ) ^ 0 local Space = ( Q " " + EOL ) ^ 1 % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} local braces = Compute_braces ( "\"" * ( 1 - S "\"" ) ^ 0 * "\"" ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} if piton.beamer then Beamer = Compute_Beamer ( 'ocaml' , braces ) end DetectedCommands = Compute_DetectedCommands ( 'ocaml' , braces ) local Q function Q ( pattern ) return Ct ( Cc ( luatexbase.catcodetables.CatcodeTableOther ) * C ( pattern ) ) + Beamer + DetectedCommands + EscapeMath + Escape end % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} local K function K ( style , pattern ) return Lc ( [[ {\PitonStyle{ ]] .. style .. "}{" ) * Q ( pattern ) * Lc "}}" end % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} local WithStyle function WithStyle ( style , pattern ) return Ct ( Cc "Open" * Cc ( [[{\PitonStyle{]] .. style .. "}{" ) * Cc "}}" ) * ( pattern + Beamer + DetectedCommands + EscapeMath + Escape ) * Ct ( Cc "Close" ) end % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % The following LPEG corresponds to the balanced expressions (balanced according % to the parenthesis). Of course, we must write |(1 - S "()")| with outer parenthesis. % \begin{macrocode} local balanced_parens = P { "E" , E = ( "(" * V "E" * ")" + ( 1 - S "()" ) ) ^ 0 } % \end{macrocode} % % \paragraph{The strings of OCaml} % \begin{macrocode} local ocaml_string = P "\"" * ( P " " + P ( ( 1 - S " \"\r" ) ^ 1 ) + EOL -- ? ) ^ 0 * P "\"" % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} local String = WithStyle ( 'String.Long.Internal' , Q "\"" * ( SpaceInString + Q ( ( 1 - S " \"\r" ) ^ 1 ) + EOL ) ^ 0 * Q "\"" ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % Now, the ``quoted strings'' of OCaml (for example \verb+{ext|Essai|ext}+). % % For those strings, we will do two consecutive analysis. First an analysis to % determine the whole string and, then, an analysis for the potential visual % spaces and the EOL in the string. % % The first analysis require a match-time capture. For explanations about that % programmation, see the paragraphe \emph{Lua's long strings} in % |www.inf.puc-rio.br/~roberto/lpeg|. % % \begin{macrocode} local ext = ( R "az" + "_" ) ^ 0 local open = "{" * Cg ( ext , 'init' ) * "|" local close = "|" * C ( ext ) * "}" local closeeq = Cmt ( close * Cb ( 'init' ) , function ( s , i , a , b ) return a == b end ) % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % The \textsc{lpeg} |QuotedStringBis| will do the second analysis. % \begin{macrocode} local QuotedStringBis = WithStyle ( 'String.Long.Internal' , ( Space + Q ( ( 1 - S " \r" ) ^ 1 ) + EOL ) ^ 0 ) % \end{macrocode} % % \medskip % We use a ``function capture'' (as called in the official documentation of the % \textsc{lpeg}) in order to do the second analysis on the result of the first one. % \begin{macrocode} local QuotedString = C ( open * ( 1 - closeeq ) ^ 0 * close ) / ( function ( s ) return QuotedStringBis : match ( s ) end ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % In OCaml, the delimiters for the comments are |(*| and |*)|. There are % unsymmetrical and OCaml allows those comments to be nested. That's why we need a % grammar. % % In these comments, we embed the math comments (between |$| and |$|) and we % embed also a treatment for the end of lines (since the comments may be multi-lines). % % \begin{macrocode} local Comment = WithStyle ( 'Comment' , P { "A" , A = Q "(*" * ( V "A" + Q ( ( 1 - S "\r$\"" - "(*" - "*)" ) ^ 1 ) -- $ + ocaml_string + "$" * K ( 'Comment.Math' , ( 1 - S "$\r" ) ^ 1 ) * "$" -- $ + EOL ) ^ 0 * Q "*)" } ) % \end{macrocode} % % % \paragraph{Some standard LPEG} % % \begin{macrocode} local Delim = Q ( P "[|" + "|]" + S "[()]" ) local Punct = Q ( S ",:;!" ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % The identifiers caught by |cap_identifier| begin with a capital. In OCaml, % it's used for the constructors of types and for the names of the modules. % % \begin{macrocode} local cap_identifier = R "AZ" * ( R "az" + R "AZ" + S "_'" + digit ) ^ 0 % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} local Constructor = K ( 'Name.Constructor' , Q "`" ^ -1 * cap_identifier % \end{macrocode} % We consider |::| and |[]| as constructors (of the lists) as does the Tuareg % mode of Emacs. % \begin{macrocode} + Q "::" + Q "[" * SkipSpace * Q "]" ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} local ModuleType = K ( 'Name.Type' , cap_identifier ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} local OperatorWord = K ( 'Operator.Word' , P "asr" + "land" + "lor" + "lsl" + "lxor" + "mod" + "or" ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % In OCaml, some keywords are considered as \emph{governing keywords} with some % special syntactic characteristics. % \begin{macrocode} local governing_keyword = P "and" + "begin" + "class" + "constraint" + "end" + "external" + "functor" + "include" + "inherit" + "initializer" + "in" + "let" + "method" + "module" + "object" + "open" + "rec" + "sig" + "struct" + "type" + "val" % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} local Keyword = K ( 'Keyword' , P "assert" + "as" + "done" + "downto" + "do" + "else" + "exception" + "for" + "function" + "fun" + "if" + "lazy" + "match" + "mutable" + "new" + "of" + "private" + "raise" + "then" + "to" + "try" + "virtual" + "when" + "while" + "with" ) + K ( 'Keyword.Constant' , P "true" + "false" ) + K ( 'Keyword.Governing', governing_keyword ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} local EndKeyword = Space + Punct + Delim + EOL + Beamer + DetectedCommands + Escape + EscapeMath + -1 % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % Now, the identifier. Recall that we have also a LPEG |cap_identifier| for the % indentifiers beginning with a capital letter. % \begin{macrocode} local identifier = ( R "az" + "_" ) * ( R "az" + R "AZ" + S "_'" + digit ) ^ 0 - ( OperatorWord + Keyword ) * EndKeyword % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % We have the internal style |Identifier.Internal| in order to be able to % implement the mechanism |\SetPitonIdentifier|. The final user has access to a % style called |Identifier|. % \begin{macrocode} local Identifier = K ( 'Identifier.Internal' , identifier ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % In OCmal, \emph{character} is a type different of the type |string|. % \begin{macrocode} local ocaml_char = P "'" * ( ( 1 - S "'\\" ) + "\\" * ( S "\\'ntbr \"" + digit * digit * digit + P "x" * ( digit + R "af" + R "AF" ) * ( digit + R "af" + R "AF" ) * ( digit + R "af" + R "AF" ) + P "o" * R "03" * R "07" * R "07" ) ) * "'" local Char = K ( 'String.Short.Internal', ocaml_char ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % For the parameter of the types (for example : |`\a| as in |`a list|). % \begin{macrocode} local TypeParameter = K ( 'TypeParameter' , "'" * Q"_" ^ -1 * alpha ^ 1 * ( # ( 1 - P "'" ) + -1 ) ) % \end{macrocode} % % \paragraph{The records} % % \begin{macrocode} local expression_for_fields_type = P { "E" , E = ( "{" * V "F" * "}" + "(" * V "F" * ")" + TypeParameter + ( 1 - S "{}()[]\r;" ) ) ^ 0 , F = ( "{" * V "F" * "}" + "(" * V "F" * ")" + ( 1 - S "{}()[]\r\"'" ) + TypeParameter ) ^ 0 } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} local expression_for_fields_value = P { "E" , E = ( "{" * V "F" * "}" + "(" * V "F" * ")" + "[" * V "F" * "]" + ocaml_string + ocaml_char + ( 1 - S "{}()[];" ) ) ^ 0 , F = ( "{" * V "F" * "}" + "(" * V "F" * ")" + "[" * V "F" * "]" + ocaml_string + ocaml_char + ( 1 - S "{}()[]\"'" )) ^ 0 } % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} local OneFieldDefinition = ( K ( 'Keyword' , "mutable" ) * SkipSpace ) ^ -1 * K ( 'Name.Field' , identifier ) * SkipSpace * Q ":" * SkipSpace * K ( 'TypeExpression' , expression_for_fields_type ) * SkipSpace % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} local OneField = K ( 'Name.Field' , identifier ) * SkipSpace * Q "=" * SkipSpace % \end{macrocode} % Don't forget the parentheses! % \begin{macrocode} * ( C ( expression_for_fields_value ) / ParseAgain ) * SkipSpace % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % The \emph{records} may occur in the definitions of type (beginning by |type|) % but also when used as values. % \begin{macrocode} local Record = Q "{" * SkipSpace * ( OneFieldDefinition * ( Q ";" * SkipSpace * ( Comment * SkipSpace ) ^ 0 * OneFieldDefinition ) ^ 0 + OneField * ( Q ";" * SkipSpace * ( Comment * SkipSpace ) ^ 0 * OneField ) ^ 0 ) * SkipSpace * Q ";" ^ -1 * SkipSpace * Comment ^ -1 * SkipSpace * Q "}" % \end{macrocode} % % \paragraph{DotNotation} % % Now, we deal with the notations with points (eg: |List.length|). In OCaml, % such notation is used for the fields of the records and for the modules. % \begin{macrocode} local DotNotation = ( K ( 'Name.Module' , cap_identifier ) * Q "." * ( Identifier + Constructor + Q "(" + Q "[" + Q "{" ) ^ -1 + Identifier * Q "." * K ( 'Name.Field' , identifier ) ) * ( Q "." * K ( 'Name.Field' , identifier ) ) ^ 0 % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} local Operator = K ( 'Operator' , P "!=" + "<>" + "==" + "<<" + ">>" + "<=" + ">=" + ":=" + "||" + "&&" + "//" + "**" + ";;" + "->" + "+." + "-." + "*." + "/." + S "-~+/*%=<>&@|" ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} local Builtin = K ( 'Name.Builtin' , P "not" + "incr" + "decr" + "fst" + "snd" + "ref" ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} local Exception = K ( 'Exception' , P "Division_by_zero" + "End_of_File" + "Failure" + "Invalid_argument" + "Match_failure" + "Not_found" + "Out_of_memory" + "Stack_overflow" + "Sys_blocked_io" + "Sys_error" + "Undefined_recursive_module" ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} LPEG_cleaner.ocaml = Compute_LPEG_cleaner ( 'ocaml' , braces ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % An argument in the definition of a OCaml function may be of the form % |(pattern:type)|. |pattern| may be a single identifier but it's not mandatory. % First instance, it's possible to write in OCaml: % % |let head (a::q) = a| % % First, we write a pattern (in the LPEG sens!) to match what will be the % pattern (in the OCaml sens). % \begin{macrocode} local pattern_part = ( P "(" * balanced_parens * ")" + ( 1 - S ":()" ) + P "::" ) ^ 0 % \end{macrocode} % For the ``type'' part, the LPEG-pattern will merely be |balanced_parens|. % % \bigskip % We can now write a LPEG |Argument| which catches a argument of function (in % the definition of the function). % \begin{macrocode} local Argument = % \end{macrocode} % The following line is for the labels of the labeled arguments. Maybe we will, % in the future, create a style for those elements. % \begin{macrocode} ( Q "~" * Identifier * Q ":" * SkipSpace ) ^ -1 * % \end{macrocode} % Now, the argument itself, either a single identifier, or a construction % between parentheses % \begin{macrocode} ( K ( 'Identifier.Internal' , identifier ) + Q "(" * SkipSpace * ( C ( pattern_part ) / ParseAgain ) * SkipSpace % \end{macrocode} % Of course, the specification of type is optional. % \begin{macrocode} * ( Q ":" * K ( 'TypeExpression' , balanced_parens ) * SkipSpace ) ^ -1 * Q ")" ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % Despite its name, then \textsc{lpeg} |DefFunction| deals also with |let open| % which opens locally a module. % \begin{macrocode} local DefFunction = K ( 'Keyword.Governing' , "let open" ) * Space * K ( 'Name.Module' , cap_identifier ) + K ( 'Keyword.Governing' , P "let rec" + "let" + "and" ) * Space * K ( 'Name.Function.Internal' , identifier ) * Space * ( Q "=" * SkipSpace * K ( 'Keyword' , "function" ) + Argument * ( SkipSpace * Argument ) ^ 0 * ( SkipSpace * Q ":" * K ( 'TypeExpression' , ( 1 - P "=" ) ^ 0 ) ) ^ -1 ) % \end{macrocode} % % \paragraph{DefModule} % % \begin{macrocode} local DefModule = K ( 'Keyword.Governing' , "module" ) * Space * ( K ( 'Keyword.Governing' , "type" ) * Space * K ( 'Name.Type' , cap_identifier ) + K ( 'Name.Module' , cap_identifier ) * SkipSpace * ( Q "(" * SkipSpace * K ( 'Name.Module' , cap_identifier ) * SkipSpace * Q ":" * SkipSpace * K ( 'Name.Type' , cap_identifier ) * SkipSpace * ( Q "," * SkipSpace * K ( 'Name.Module' , cap_identifier ) * SkipSpace * Q ":" * SkipSpace * K ( 'Name.Type' , cap_identifier ) * SkipSpace ) ^ 0 * Q ")" ) ^ -1 * ( Q "=" * SkipSpace * K ( 'Name.Module' , cap_identifier ) * SkipSpace * Q "(" * K ( 'Name.Module' , cap_identifier ) * SkipSpace * ( Q "," * K ( 'Name.Module' , cap_identifier ) * SkipSpace ) ^ 0 * Q ")" ) ^ -1 ) + K ( 'Keyword.Governing' , P "include" + "open" ) * Space * K ( 'Name.Module' , cap_identifier ) % \end{macrocode} % % \paragraph{DefType} % % \begin{macrocode} local DefType = K ( 'Keyword.Governing' , "type" ) * Space * K ( 'TypeExpression' , Q ( 1 - P "=" ) ^ 1 ) * SkipSpace * ( Q "+=" + Q "=" ) * SkipSpace * ( Record + WithStyle ( 'TypeExpression' , ( ( EOL + Q ( 1 - P ";;" - governing_keyword ) ) ^ 0 * ( # ( governing_keyword ) + Q ";;" ) ) ) ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \paragraph{The main LPEG for the language OCaml} % % \begin{macrocode} local Main = space ^ 0 * EOL + Space + Tab + Escape + EscapeMath + Beamer + DetectedCommands + TypeParameter + String + QuotedString + Char + Comment + Operator % \end{macrocode} % For the labels (maybe we will write in the future a dedicated LPEG pour those tokens). % \begin{macrocode} + Q "~" * Identifier * ( Q ":" ) ^ -1 + Q ":" * # (1 - P ":") * SkipSpace * K ( 'TypeExpression' , balanced_parens ) * SkipSpace * Q ")" + Exception + DefType + DefFunction + DefModule + Record + Keyword * EndKeyword + OperatorWord * EndKeyword + Builtin * EndKeyword + DotNotation + Constructor + Identifier + Punct + Delim + Number + Word % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % % Here, we must not put |local|, of course. % \begin{macrocode} LPEG1.ocaml = Main ^ 0 % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} LPEG2.ocaml = Ct ( % \end{macrocode} % The following lines are in order to allow, in |\piton| (and not in |{Piton}|), % judgments of type (such as |f : my_type -> 'a list|) or single expressions of % type such as |my_type -> 'a list| (in that case, the argument of |\piton| % \emph{must} begin by a colon). % \begin{macrocode} ( P ":" + Identifier * SkipSpace * Q ":" ) * # ( 1 - P ":" ) * SkipSpace * K ( 'TypeExpression' , ( 1 - P "\r" ) ^ 0 ) + ( space ^ 0 * "\r" ) ^ -1 * BeamerBeginEnvironments * Lc [[ \@@_begin_line: ]] * SpaceIndentation ^ 0 * ( ( space * Lc [[ \@@_trailing_space: ]] ) ^ 1 * -1 + space ^ 0 * EOL + Main ) ^ 0 * -1 * Lc [[ \@@_end_line: ]] ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % End of the Lua scope for the language OCaml. % \begin{macrocode} end % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % \subsubsection{The language C} % % We open a Lua local scope for the language C (of course, there will be also % global definitions). % \begin{macrocode} do % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} local Delim = Q ( S "{[()]}" ) % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} local Punct = Q ( S ",:;!" ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % Some strings of length 2 are explicit because we want the corresponding % ligatures available in some fonts such as \emph{Fira Code} to be active. % \begin{macrocode} local identifier = letter * alphanum ^ 0 local Operator = K ( 'Operator' , P "!=" + "==" + "<<" + ">>" + "<=" + ">=" + "||" + "&&" + S "-~+/*%=<>&.@|!" ) local Keyword = K ( 'Keyword' , P "alignas" + "asm" + "auto" + "break" + "case" + "catch" + "class" + "const" + "constexpr" + "continue" + "decltype" + "do" + "else" + "enum" + "extern" + "for" + "goto" + "if" + "nexcept" + "private" + "public" + "register" + "restricted" + "return" + "static" + "static_assert" + "struct" + "switch" + "thread_local" + "throw" + "try" + "typedef" + "union" + "using" + "virtual" + "volatile" + "while" ) + K ( 'Keyword.Constant' , P "default" + "false" + "NULL" + "nullptr" + "true" ) local Builtin = K ( 'Name.Builtin' , P "alignof" + "malloc" + "printf" + "scanf" + "sizeof" ) local Type = K ( 'Name.Type' , P "bool" + "char" + "char16_t" + "char32_t" + "double" + "float" + "int" + "int8_t" + "int16_t" + "int32_t" + "int64_t" + "long" + "short" + "signed" + "unsigned" + "void" + "wchar_t" ) * Q "*" ^ 0 local DefFunction = Type * Space * Q "*" ^ -1 * K ( 'Name.Function.Internal' , identifier ) * SkipSpace * # P "(" % \end{macrocode} % We remind that the marker |#| of \textsc{lpeg} specifies that the pattern will be % detected but won't consume any character. % % \bigskip % The following \textsc{lpeg} |DefClass| will be used to detect the definition of a % new class (the name of that new class will be formatted with the \pkg{piton} % style |Name.Class|). % % \smallskip % Example:\enskip \piton{class myclass:} % \begin{macrocode} local DefClass = K ( 'Keyword' , "class" ) * Space * K ( 'Name.Class' , identifier ) % \end{macrocode} % % If the word |class| is not followed by a identifier, it will be caught as % keyword by the \textsc{lpeg} |Keyword| (useful if we want to type a % list of keywords). % % \bigskip % \paragraph{The strings of C} % % \begin{macrocode} String = WithStyle ( 'String.Long.Internal' , Q "\"" * ( SpaceInString + K ( 'String.Interpol' , "%" * ( S "difcspxXou" + "ld" + "li" + "hd" + "hi" ) ) + Q ( ( P "\\\"" + 1 - S " \"" ) ^ 1 ) ) ^ 0 * Q "\"" ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \paragraph{Beamer} % % \bigskip % The argument of |Compute_braces| must be a pattern \emph{which does no % catching} corresponding to the strings of the language. % \begin{macrocode} local braces = Compute_braces ( "\"" * ( 1 - S "\"" ) ^ 0 * "\"" ) if piton.beamer then Beamer = Compute_Beamer ( 'c' , braces ) end % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} DetectedCommands = Compute_DetectedCommands ( 'c' , braces ) % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} LPEG_cleaner.c = Compute_LPEG_cleaner ( 'c' , braces ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \paragraph{The directives of the preprocessor} % % \begin{macrocode} local Preproc = K ( 'Preproc' , "#" * ( 1 - P "\r" ) ^ 0 ) * ( EOL + -1 ) % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % \paragraph{The comments in the C listings} % % We define different \textsc{lpeg} dealing with comments in the C listings. % \begin{macrocode} local Comment = WithStyle ( 'Comment' , Q "//" * ( CommentMath + Q ( ( 1 - S "$\r" ) ^ 1 ) ) ^ 0 ) -- $ * ( EOL + -1 ) local LongComment = WithStyle ( 'Comment' , Q "/*" * ( CommentMath + Q ( ( 1 - P "*/" - S "$\r" ) ^ 1 ) + EOL ) ^ 0 * Q "*/" ) -- $ % \end{macrocode} % % % % % \bigskip % \paragraph{The main LPEG for the language C} % % \begin{macrocode} local EndKeyword = Space + Punct + Delim + EOL + Beamer + DetectedCommands + Escape + EscapeMath + -1 % \end{macrocode} % % First, the main loop : % \begin{macrocode} local Main = space ^ 0 * EOL + Space + Tab + Escape + EscapeMath + CommentLaTeX + Beamer + DetectedCommands + Preproc + Comment + LongComment + Delim + Operator + String + Punct + DefFunction + DefClass + Type * ( Q "*" ^ -1 + EndKeyword ) + Keyword * EndKeyword + Builtin * EndKeyword + Identifier + Number + Word % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % Here, we must not put |local|, of course. % \begin{macrocode} LPEG1.c = Main ^ 0 % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % We recall that each line in the C code to parse will be sent back to % LaTeX between a pair |\@@_begin_line:| -- |\@@_end_line:|\footnote{Remember % that the \texttt{\textbackslash @@\_end\_line:} must be explicit because it % will be used as marker in order to delimit the argument of the command % \texttt{\textbackslash @@\_begin\_line:}}. % \begin{macrocode} LPEG2.c = Ct ( ( space ^ 0 * P "\r" ) ^ -1 * BeamerBeginEnvironments * Lc [[ \@@_begin_line: ]] * SpaceIndentation ^ 0 * ( space ^ 1 * -1 + space ^ 0 * EOL + Main ) ^ 0 * -1 * Lc [[ \@@_end_line: ]] ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % End of the Lua scope for the language C. % \begin{macrocode} end % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \subsubsection{The language SQL} % % We open a Lua local scope for the language SQL (of course, there will be also % global definitions). % \begin{macrocode} do % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} local LuaKeyword function LuaKeyword ( name ) return Lc [[ {\PitonStyle{Keyword}{ ]] * Q ( Cmt ( C ( letter * alphanum ^ 0 ) , function ( s , i , a ) return string.upper ( a ) == name end ) ) * Lc "}}" end % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % In the identifiers, we will be able to catch those contening spaces, that is % to say like |"last name"|. % \begin{macrocode} local identifier = letter * ( alphanum + "-" ) ^ 0 + P '"' * ( ( 1 - P '"' ) ^ 1 ) * '"' % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} local Operator = K ( 'Operator' , P "=" + "!=" + "<>" + ">=" + ">" + "<=" + "<" + S "*+/" ) % \end{macrocode} % % In SQL, the keywords are case-insensitive. That's why we have a little % complication. We will catch the keywords with the identifiers and, then, % distinguish the keywords with a Lua function. However, some keywords will be % caught in special LPEG because we want to detect the names of the SQL tables. % % \bigskip % The following function converts a comma-separated list in a ``set'', that is % to say a Lua table with a fast way to test whether a string belongs to that % set (eventually, the indexation of the components of the table is no longer % done by integers but by the strings themselves). % \begin{macrocode} local Set function Set ( list ) local set = { } for _ , l in ipairs ( list ) do set[l] = true end return set end % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % We now use the previous function |Set| to creates the ``sets'' |set_keywords| % and |set_builtin|. That list of keywords comes from % \url{https://sqlite.org/lang_keywords.html}. % \begin{macrocode} local set_keywords = Set { "ABORT", "ACTION", "ADD", "AFTER", "ALL", "ALTER", "ALWAYS", "ANALYZE", "AND", "AS", "ASC", "ATTACH", "AUTOINCREMENT", "BEFORE", "BEGIN", "BETWEEN", "BY", "CASCADE", "CASE", "CAST", "CHECK", "COLLATE", "COLUMN", "COMMIT", "CONFLICT", "CONSTRAINT", "CREATE", "CROSS", "CURRENT", "CURRENT_DATE", "CURRENT_TIME", "CURRENT_TIMESTAMP", "DATABASE", "DEFAULT", "DEFERRABLE", "DEFERRED", "DELETE", "DESC", "DETACH", "DISTINCT", "DO", "DROP", "EACH", "ELSE", "END", "ESCAPE", "EXCEPT", "EXCLUDE", "EXCLUSIVE", "EXISTS", "EXPLAIN", "FAIL", "FILTER", "FIRST", "FOLLOWING", "FOR", "FOREIGN", "FROM", "FULL", "GENERATED", "GLOB", "GROUP", "GROUPS", "HAVING", "IF", "IGNORE", "IMMEDIATE", "IN", "INDEX", "INDEXED", "INITIALLY", "INNER", "INSERT", "INSTEAD", "INTERSECT", "INTO", "IS", "ISNULL", "JOIN", "KEY", "LAST", "LEFT", "LIKE", "LIMIT", "MATCH", "MATERIALIZED", "NATURAL", "NO", "NOT", "NOTHING", "NOTNULL", "NULL", "NULLS", "OF", "OFFSET", "ON", "OR", "ORDER", "OTHERS", "OUTER", "OVER", "PARTITION", "PLAN", "PRAGMA", "PRECEDING", "PRIMARY", "QUERY", "RAISE", "RANGE", "RECURSIVE", "REFERENCES", "REGEXP", "REINDEX", "RELEASE", "RENAME", "REPLACE", "RESTRICT", "RETURNING", "RIGHT", "ROLLBACK", "ROW", "ROWS", "SAVEPOINT", "SELECT", "SET", "TABLE", "TEMP", "TEMPORARY", "THEN", "TIES", "TO", "TRANSACTION", "TRIGGER", "UNBOUNDED", "UNION", "UNIQUE", "UPDATE", "USING", "VACUUM", "VALUES", "VIEW", "VIRTUAL", "WHEN", "WHERE", "WINDOW", "WITH", "WITHOUT" } % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} local set_builtins = Set { "AVG" , "COUNT" , "CHAR_LENGTH" , "CONCAT" , "CURDATE" , "CURRENT_DATE" , "DATE_FORMAT" , "DAY" , "LOWER" , "LTRIM" , "MAX" , "MIN" , "MONTH" , "NOW" , "RANK" , "ROUND" , "RTRIM" , "SUBSTRING" , "SUM" , "UPPER" , "YEAR" } % \end{macrocode} % % The \textsc{lpeg} |Identifier| will catch the identifiers of the fields % but also the keywords and the built-in functions of SQL. If will \emph{not} % catch the names of the SQL tables. % \begin{macrocode} local Identifier = C ( identifier ) / ( function ( s ) if set_keywords[string.upper(s)] then return % \end{macrocode} % Remind that, in Lua, it's possible to return \emph{several} values. % \begin{macrocode} { [[{\PitonStyle{Keyword}{]] } , { luatexbase.catcodetables.other , s } , { "}}" } else if set_builtins[string.upper(s)] then return { [[{\PitonStyle{Name.Builtin}{]] } , { luatexbase.catcodetables.other , s } , { "}}" } else return { [[{\PitonStyle{Name.Field}{]] } , { luatexbase.catcodetables.other , s } , { "}}" } end end end ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \paragraph{The strings of SQL} % % \begin{macrocode} local String = K ( 'String.Long.Internal' , "'" * ( 1 - P "'" ) ^ 1 * "'" ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \paragraph{Beamer} % % \bigskip % The argument of |Compute_braces| must be a pattern \emph{which does no % catching} corresponding to the strings of the language. % % \begin{macrocode} local braces = Compute_braces ( "'" * ( 1 - P "'" ) ^ 1 * "'" ) if piton.beamer then Beamer = Compute_Beamer ( 'sql' , braces ) end % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} DetectedCommands = Compute_DetectedCommands ( 'sql' , braces ) % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} LPEG_cleaner.sql = Compute_LPEG_cleaner ( 'sql' , braces ) % \end{macrocode} % % % % \bigskip % \paragraph{The comments in the SQL listings} % % We define different \textsc{lpeg} dealing with comments in the SQL listings. % \begin{macrocode} local Comment = WithStyle ( 'Comment' , Q "--" -- syntax of SQL92 * ( CommentMath + Q ( ( 1 - S "$\r" ) ^ 1 ) ) ^ 0 ) -- $ * ( EOL + -1 ) local LongComment = WithStyle ( 'Comment' , Q "/*" * ( CommentMath + Q ( ( 1 - P "*/" - S "$\r" ) ^ 1 ) + EOL ) ^ 0 * Q "*/" ) -- $ % \end{macrocode} % % % % \bigskip % \paragraph{The main LPEG for the language SQL} % % \begin{macrocode} local EndKeyword = Space + Punct + Delim + EOL + Beamer + DetectedCommands + Escape + EscapeMath + -1 % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} local TableField = K ( 'Name.Table' , identifier ) * Q "." * K ( 'Name.Field' , identifier ) local OneField = ( Q ( "(" * ( 1 - P ")" ) ^ 0 * ")" ) + K ( 'Name.Table' , identifier ) * Q "." * K ( 'Name.Field' , identifier ) + K ( 'Name.Field' , identifier ) ) * ( Space * LuaKeyword "AS" * Space * K ( 'Name.Field' , identifier ) ) ^ -1 * ( Space * ( LuaKeyword "ASC" + LuaKeyword "DESC" ) ) ^ -1 local OneTable = K ( 'Name.Table' , identifier ) * ( Space * LuaKeyword "AS" * Space * K ( 'Name.Table' , identifier ) ) ^ -1 local WeCatchTableNames = LuaKeyword "FROM" * ( Space + EOL ) * OneTable * ( SkipSpace * Q "," * SkipSpace * OneTable ) ^ 0 + ( LuaKeyword "JOIN" + LuaKeyword "INTO" + LuaKeyword "UPDATE" + LuaKeyword "TABLE" ) * ( Space + EOL ) * OneTable % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} local EndKeyword = Space + Punct + Delim + EOL + Beamer + DetectedCommands + Escape + EscapeMath + -1 % \end{macrocode} % % % First, the main loop : % \begin{macrocode} local Main = space ^ 0 * EOL + Space + Tab + Escape + EscapeMath + CommentLaTeX + Beamer + DetectedCommands + Comment + LongComment + Delim + Operator + String + Punct + WeCatchTableNames + ( TableField + Identifier ) * ( Space + Operator + Punct + Delim + EOL + -1 ) + Number + Word % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % Here, we must not put |local|, of course. % \begin{macrocode} LPEG1.sql = Main ^ 0 % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % We recall that each line in the code to parse will be sent back to % LaTeX between a pair |\@@_begin_line:| -- |\@@_end_line:|\footnote{Remember % that the \texttt{\textbackslash @@\_end\_line:} must be explicit because it % will be used as marker in order to delimit the argument of the command % \texttt{\textbackslash @@\_begin\_line:}}. % \begin{macrocode} LPEG2.sql = Ct ( ( space ^ 0 * "\r" ) ^ -1 * BeamerBeginEnvironments * Lc [[ \@@_begin_line: ]] * SpaceIndentation ^ 0 * ( space ^ 1 * -1 + space ^ 0 * EOL + Main ) ^ 0 * -1 * Lc [[ \@@_end_line: ]] ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % End of the Lua scope for the language SQL. % \begin{macrocode} end % \end{macrocode} % % \subsubsection{The language ``Minimal''} % % We open a Lua local scope for the language ``Minimal'' (of course, there % will be also global definitions). % \begin{macrocode} do % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} local Punct = Q ( S ",:;!\\" ) local Comment = WithStyle ( 'Comment' , Q "#" * ( CommentMath + Q ( ( 1 - S "$\r" ) ^ 1 ) ) ^ 0 -- $ ) * ( EOL + -1 ) local String = WithStyle ( 'String.Short.Internal' , Q "\"" * ( SpaceInString + Q ( ( P "\\\"" + 1 - S " \"" ) ^ 1 ) ) ^ 0 * Q "\"" ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % The argument of |Compute_braces| must be a pattern \emph{which does no % catching} corresponding to the strings of the language. % \begin{macrocode} local braces = Compute_braces ( P "\"" * ( P "\\\"" + 1 - P "\"" ) ^ 1 * "\"" ) if piton.beamer then Beamer = Compute_Beamer ( 'minimal' , braces ) end DetectedCommands = Compute_DetectedCommands ( 'minimal' , braces ) LPEG_cleaner.minimal = Compute_LPEG_cleaner ( 'minimal' , braces ) local identifier = letter * alphanum ^ 0 local Identifier = K ( 'Identifier.Internal' , identifier ) local Delim = Q ( S "{[()]}" ) local Main = space ^ 0 * EOL + Space + Tab + Escape + EscapeMath + CommentLaTeX + Beamer + DetectedCommands + Comment + Delim + String + Punct + Identifier + Number + Word % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % Here, we must not put |local|, of course. % \begin{macrocode} LPEG1.minimal = Main ^ 0 LPEG2.minimal = Ct ( ( space ^ 0 * "\r" ) ^ -1 * BeamerBeginEnvironments * Lc [[ \@@_begin_line: ]] * SpaceIndentation ^ 0 * ( space ^ 1 * -1 + space ^ 0 * EOL + Main ) ^ 0 * -1 * Lc [[ \@@_end_line: ]] ) % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % End of the Lua scope for the language ``Minimal''. % \begin{macrocode} end % \end{macrocode} % % \subsubsection{The language ``Verbatim''} % % We open a Lua local scope for the language ``Verbatim'' (of course, there % will be also global definitions). % \begin{macrocode} do % \end{macrocode} % \bigskip % Here, we don't use |braces| as done with the other languages because we don't % have have to take into account the strings (there is no string in the langage % ``Verbatim''). % \begin{macrocode} local braces = P { "E" , E = ( "{" * V "E" * "}" + ( 1 - S "{}" ) ) ^ 0 } if piton.beamer then Beamer = Compute_Beamer ( 'verbatim' , braces ) end DetectedCommands = Compute_DetectedCommands ( 'verbatim' , braces ) LPEG_cleaner.verbatim = Compute_LPEG_cleaner ( 'verbatim' , braces ) % \end{macrocode} % % Now, you will construct the LPEG Word. % \begin{macrocode} local lpeg_central = 1 - S " \\\r" if piton.begin_escape then lpeg_central = lpeg_central - piton.begin_escape end if piton.begin_escape_math then lpeg_central = lpeg_central - piton.begin_escape_math end local Word = Q ( lpeg_central ^ 1 ) local Main = space ^ 0 * EOL + Space + Tab + Escape + EscapeMath + Beamer + DetectedCommands + Q [[\]] + Word % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % Here, we must not put |local|, of course. % \begin{macrocode} LPEG1.verbatim = Main ^ 0 LPEG2.verbatim = Ct ( ( space ^ 0 * "\r" ) ^ -1 * BeamerBeginEnvironments * Lc [[ \@@_begin_line: ]] * SpaceIndentation ^ 0 * ( space ^ 1 * -1 + space ^ 0 * EOL + Main ) ^ 0 * -1 * Lc [[ \@@_end_line: ]] ) % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % End of the Lua scope for the language ``|verbatim|''. % \begin{macrocode} end % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \subsubsection{The function Parse} % % \medskip % The function |Parse| is the main function of the package \pkg{piton}. It % parses its argument and sends back to LaTeX the code with interlaced % formatting LaTeX instructions. In fact, everything is done by the % \textsc{lpeg} corresponding to the considered language (|LPEG2[language]|) % which returns as capture a Lua table containing data to send to LaTeX. % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} function piton.Parse ( language , code ) % \end{macrocode} % The variable |piton.language| will be used by the function |ParseAgain|. % \begin{macrocode} piton.language = language local t = LPEG2[language] : match ( code ) if t == nil then sprintL3 [[ \@@_error_or_warning:n { SyntaxError } ]] return -- to exit in force the function end local left_stack = {} local right_stack = {} for _ , one_item in ipairs ( t ) do if one_item[1] == "EOL" then for _ , s in ipairs ( right_stack ) do tex.sprint ( s ) end for _ , s in ipairs ( one_item[2] ) do tex.tprint ( s ) end for _ , s in ipairs ( left_stack ) do tex.sprint ( s ) end else % \end{macrocode} % % Here is an example of an item beginning with |"Open"|. % % |{ "Open" , "\begin{uncover}<2>" , "\end{uncover}" }| % % In order to deal with the ends of lines, we have to close the environment % (|{uncover}| in this example) at the end of each line and reopen it at the % beginning of the new line. That's why we use two Lua stacks, called % |left_stack| and |right_stack|. |left_stack| will be for the elements like % |\begin{uncover}<2>| and |right_stack| will be for the elements like % |\end{uncover}|. % \begin{macrocode} if one_item[1] == "Open" then tex.sprint( one_item[2] ) table.insert ( left_stack , one_item[2] ) table.insert ( right_stack , one_item[3] ) else if one_item[1] == "Close" then tex.sprint ( right_stack[#right_stack] ) left_stack[#left_stack] = nil right_stack[#right_stack] = nil else tex.tprint ( one_item ) end end end end end % \end{macrocode} % % % % \bigskip % The function |ParseFile| will be used by the LaTeX command |\PitonInputFile|. % That function merely reads the file (between |first_line| and |last_line|) and % then apply the function~|Parse| to the resulting Lua string. % \begin{macrocode} function piton.ParseFile ( lang , name , first_line , last_line , splittable , split ) local s = '' local i = 0 % \end{macrocode} % At the date of septembre 2024, LuaLaTeX uses Lua 5.3 and not 5.4. In the % version 5.4, |io.lines| returns four values (and not just one) but the % following code should be correct. % \begin{macrocode} for line in io.lines ( name ) do i = i + 1 if i >= first_line then s = s .. '\r' .. line end if i >= last_line then break end end % \end{macrocode} % We extract the BOM of utf-8, if present. % \begin{macrocode} if string.byte ( s , 1 ) == 13 then if string.byte ( s , 2 ) == 239 then if string.byte ( s , 3 ) == 187 then if string.byte ( s , 4 ) == 191 then s = string.sub ( s , 5 , -1 ) end end end end if split == 1 then piton.RetrieveGobbleSplitParse ( lang , 0 , splittable , s ) else piton.RetrieveGobbleParse ( lang , 0 , splittable , s ) end end % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} function piton.RetrieveGobbleParse ( lang , n , splittable , code ) local s s = ( ( P " " ^ 0 * "\r" ) ^ -1 * C ( P ( 1 ) ^ 0 ) * -1 ) : match ( code ) piton.GobbleParse ( lang , n , splittable , s ) end % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \subsubsection{Two variants of the function Parse with integrated preprocessors} % % The following command will be used by the user command |\piton|. % For that command, we have to undo the duplication of the symbols |#|. % \begin{macrocode} function piton.ParseBis ( lang , code ) local s = ( Cs ( ( P '##' / '#' + 1 ) ^ 0 ) ) : match ( code ) return piton.Parse ( lang , s ) end % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % The following command will be used when we have to parse some small chunks of % code that have yet been parsed. They are re-scanned by LaTeX because it has % been required by |\@@_piton:n| in the \pkg{piton} style of the syntaxic % element. In that case, you have to remove the potential |\@@_breakable_space:| % that have been inserted when the key |break-lines| is in force. % \begin{macrocode} function piton.ParseTer ( lang , code ) % \end{macrocode} % Be careful: we have to write |[[\@@_breakable_space: ]]| with a space after % the name of the LaTeX command |\@@_breakable_space:|. % \begin{macrocode} local s s = ( Cs ( ( P [[\@@_breakable_space: ]] / ' ' + 1 ) ^ 0 ) ) : match ( code ) % \end{macrocode} % Remember that |\@@_leading_space:| does not create a space, only an % incrementation of the counter |\g_@@_indentation_int|. That's why we don't % replace it by a space... % \begin{macrocode} s = ( Cs ( ( P [[\@@_leading_space: ]] / '' + 1 ) ^ 0 ) ) : match ( s ) return piton.Parse ( lang , s ) end % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % \subsubsection{Preprocessors of the function Parse for gobble} % % We deal now with preprocessors of the function |Parse| which are needed when % the ``gobble mechanism'' is used. % % % \bigskip % The following \textsc{lpeg} returns as capture the minimal number of spaces at % the beginning of the lines of code. % \begin{macrocode} local AutoGobbleLPEG = ( ( P " " ^ 0 * "\r" + Ct ( C " " ^ 0 ) / table.getn * ( 1 - P " " ) * ( 1 - P "\r" ) ^ 0 * "\r" ) ^ 0 * ( Ct ( C " " ^ 0 ) / table.getn * ( 1 - P " " ) * ( 1 - P "\r" ) ^ 0 ) ^ -1 ) / math.min % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % The following \textsc{lpeg} is similar but works with the tabulations. % \begin{macrocode} local TabsAutoGobbleLPEG = ( ( P "\t" ^ 0 * "\r" + Ct ( C "\t" ^ 0 ) / table.getn * ( 1 - P "\t" ) * ( 1 - P "\r" ) ^ 0 * "\r" ) ^ 0 * ( Ct ( C "\t" ^ 0 ) / table.getn * ( 1 - P "\t" ) * ( 1 - P "\r" ) ^ 0 ) ^ -1 ) / math.min % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % The following \textsc{lpeg} returns as capture the number of spaces at the % last line, that is to say before the |\end{Piton}| (and usually it's also the % number of spaces before the corresponding |\begin{Piton}| because that's the % traditional way to indent in LaTeX). % \begin{macrocode} local EnvGobbleLPEG = ( ( 1 - P "\r" ) ^ 0 * "\r" ) ^ 0 * Ct ( C " " ^ 0 * -1 ) / table.getn % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} local remove_before_cr function remove_before_cr ( input_string ) local match_result = ( P "\r" ) : match ( input_string ) if match_result then return string.sub ( input_string , match_result ) else return input_string end end % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % The function |gobble| gobbles $n$ characters on the left of the code. The % negative values of $n$ have special significations. % \begin{macrocode} local gobble function gobble ( n , code ) code = remove_before_cr ( code ) if n == 0 then return code else if n == -1 then n = AutoGobbleLPEG : match ( code ) else if n == -2 then n = EnvGobbleLPEG : match ( code ) else if n == -3 then n = TabsAutoGobbleLPEG : match ( code ) end end end % \end{macrocode} % We have a second test |if n == 0| because the, even if the key like % |auto-gobble| is in force, it's possible that, in fact, there is no space to % gobble... % \begin{macrocode} if n == 0 then return code else return % \end{macrocode} % We will now use a \textsc{lpeg} that we have to compute dynamically because it % depends on the value of~$n$. % \begin{macrocode} ( Ct ( ( 1 - P "\r" ) ^ (-n) * C ( ( 1 - P "\r" ) ^ 0 ) * ( C "\r" * ( 1 - P "\r" ) ^ (-n) * C ( ( 1 - P "\r" ) ^ 0 ) ) ^ 0 ) / table.concat ) : match ( code ) end end end % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % % \bigskip % In the following code, |n| is the value of |\l_@@_gobble_int|. % % |splittable| is the value of |\l_@@_splittable_int|. % \begin{macrocode} function piton.GobbleParse ( lang , n , splittable , code ) piton.ComputeLinesStatus ( code , splittable ) piton.last_code = gobble ( n , code ) piton.last_language = lang % \end{macrocode} % We count the number of lines of the informatic code. The result will be stored % by Lua in |\l_@@_nb_lines_int|. % \begin{macrocode} piton.CountLines ( piton.last_code ) sprintL3 [[ \bool_if:NT \g_@@_footnote_bool \savenotes ]] piton.Parse ( lang , piton.last_code ) % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} sprintL3 [[ \vspace{2.5pt} ]] sprintL3 [[ \bool_if:NT \g_@@_footnote_bool \endsavenotes ]] % \end{macrocode} % We finish the paragraph (each line of the listing is composed in a TeX box % --- with potentially several lines when |break-lines-in-Piton| is in force --- % put alone in a paragraph. % \begin{macrocode} sprintL3 [[ \par ]] % \end{macrocode} % % Now, if the final user has used the key |write| to write the code of the % environment on an external file. % \begin{macrocode} if piton.write and piton.write ~= '' then local file = io.open ( piton.write , piton.write_mode ) if file then file : write ( piton.get_last_code ( ) ) file : close ( ) else sprintL3 [[ \@@_error_or_warning:n { FileError } ]] end end end % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % The following function will be used when the key |split-on-empty-lines| is in % force. With that key, the informatic code is split in chunks at the empty % lines (usually between the informatic functions defined in the informatic % code). LaTeX will be able to change the page between the chunks. The second % argument |n| corresponds to the value of the key |gobble| (number of spaces to % gobble). % \begin{macrocode} function piton.GobbleSplitParse ( lang , n , splittable , code ) local chunks chunks = ( Ct ( ( P " " ^ 0 * "\r" + C ( ( ( 1 - P "\r" ) ^ 1 * "\r" - ( P " " ^ 0 * "\r" ) ) ^ 1 ) ) ^ 0 ) ) : match ( gobble ( n , code ) ) sprintL3 [[ \begingroup ]] sprintL3 ( [[ \PitonOptions { split-on-empty-lines = false, gobble = 0, ]] .. "language = " .. lang .. "," .. "splittable = " .. splittable .. "}" ) for k , v in pairs ( chunks ) do if k > 1 then sprintL3 [[ \l_@@_split_separation_tl ]] end tex.sprint ( [[\begin{]] .. piton.env_used_by_split .. "}\r" .. v .. [[\end{]] .. piton.env_used_by_split .. "}" ) end sprintL3 [[ \endgroup ]] end % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} function piton.RetrieveGobbleSplitParse ( lang , n , splittable , code ) local s s = ( ( P " " ^ 0 * "\r" ) ^ -1 * C ( P ( 1 ) ^ 0 ) * -1 ) : match ( code ) piton.GobbleSplitParse ( lang , n , splittable , s ) end % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % The following Lua string will be inserted between the chunks of code created % when the key |split-on-empty-lines| is in force. It's used only once: you have % given a name to that Lua string only for legibily. The token list % |\l_@@_split_separation_tl| corresponds to the key |split-separation|. That % token list must contain elements inserted in \emph{vertical mode} of TeX. % \begin{macrocode} piton.string_between_chunks = [[ \par \l_@@_split_separation_tl \mode_leave_vertical: ]] .. [[ \int_gzero:N \g_@@_line_int ]] % \end{macrocode} % The counter |\g_@@_line_int| will be used to control the points where the code % may be broken by a change of page (see the key |splittable|). % % \bigskip % The following public Lua function is provided to the developer. % \begin{macrocode} function piton.get_last_code ( ) return LPEG_cleaner[piton.last_language] : match ( piton.last_code ) end % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % % \subsubsection{To count the number of lines} % % \begin{macrocode} function piton.CountLines ( code ) local count = 0 count = ( Ct ( ( ( 1 - P "\r" ) ^ 0 * C "\r" ) ^ 0 * ( ( 1 - P "\r" ) ^ 1 * Cc "\r" ) ^ -1 * -1 ) / table.getn ) : match ( code ) sprintL3 ( string.format ( [[ \int_set:Nn \l_@@_nb_lines_int { %i } ]] , count ) ) end % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % The following function is only used once (in |piton.GobbleParse|). We have % written an autonomous function only for legibility. The number of lines of the % code will be stored in |\l_@@_nb_non_empty_lines_int|. It will be used to % compute the largest number of lines to write (when |line-numbers| is in force). % \begin{macrocode} function piton.CountNonEmptyLines ( code ) local count = 0 count = ( Ct ( ( P " " ^ 0 * "\r" + ( 1 - P "\r" ) ^ 0 * C "\r" ) ^ 0 * ( 1 - P "\r" ) ^ 0 * -1 ) / table.getn ) : match ( code ) sprintL3 ( string.format ( [[ \int_set:Nn \l_@@_nb_non_empty_lines_int { %i } ]] , count ) ) end % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} function piton.CountLinesFile ( name ) local count = 0 for line in io.lines ( name ) do count = count + 1 end sprintL3 ( string.format ( [[ \int_set:Nn \l_@@_nb_lines_int { %i } ]], count ) ) end % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} function piton.CountNonEmptyLinesFile ( name ) local count = 0 for line in io.lines ( name ) do if not ( ( P " " ^ 0 * -1 ) : match ( line ) ) then count = count + 1 end end sprintL3 ( string.format ( [[ \int_set:Nn \l_@@_nb_non_empty_lines_int { % i } ]] , count ) ) end % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % The following function stores in |\l_@@_first_line_int| and % |\l_@@_last_line_int| the numbers of lines of the file |file_name| % corresponding to the strings |marker_beginning| and |marker_end|. % \begin{macrocode} function piton.ComputeRange(marker_beginning,marker_end,file_name) local s = ( Cs ( ( P '##' / '#' + 1 ) ^ 0 ) ) : match ( marker_beginning ) local t = ( Cs ( ( P '##' / '#' + 1 ) ^ 0 ) ) : match ( marker_end ) local first_line = -1 local count = 0 local last_found = false for line in io.lines ( file_name ) do if first_line == -1 then if string.sub ( line , 1 , #s ) == s then first_line = count end else if string.sub ( line , 1 , #t ) == t then last_found = true break end end count = count + 1 end if first_line == -1 then sprintL3 [[ \@@_error_or_warning:n { begin~marker~not~found } ]] else if last_found == false then sprintL3 [[ \@@_error_or_warning:n { end~marker~not~found } ]] end end sprintL3 ( [[ \int_set:Nn \l_@@_first_line_int { ]] .. first_line .. ' + 2 }' .. [[ \int_set:Nn \l_@@_last_line_int { ]] .. count .. ' }' ) end % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \subsubsection{To determine the empty lines of the listings} % % Despite its name, the Lua function |ComputeLinesStatus| computes % |piton.lines_status| but also |piton.empty_lines|. % % \medskip % In |piton.empty_lines|, a line will have the number 0 if it's a empty line (in % fact a blank line, with only spaces) and 1 elsewhere. % % \medskip % In |piton.lines_status|, each line will have a status with regard the % breaking points allowed (for the changes of pages). % \begin{itemize} % \item 0 if the line is empty and a page break is allowed; % \item 1 if the line is not empty but a page break is allowed after that line; % \item 2 if a page break is \emph{not} allowed after that line (empty or not empty). % \end{itemize} % % \medskip % |splittable| is the value of |\l_@@_splittable_int|. % However, if |splittable-on-empty-lines| is in force, |splittable| is the % opposite of |\l_@@_splittable_int|. % \begin{macrocode} function piton.ComputeLinesStatus ( code , splittable ) % \end{macrocode} % The lines in the listings which correspond to the beginning or the end of an % environment of Beamer (eg. |\begin{uncoverenv}|) must be retrieved (those % lines have \emph{no} number and therefore, \emph{no} status). % \begin{macrocode} local lpeg_line_beamer if piton.beamer then lpeg_line_beamer = space ^ 0 * P [[\begin{]] * piton.BeamerEnvironments * "}" * ( "<" * ( 1 - P ">" ) ^ 0 * ">" ) ^ -1 + space ^ 0 * P [[\end{]] * piton.BeamerEnvironments * "}" else lpeg_line_beamer = P ( false ) end % \end{macrocode} % \begin{macrocode} local lpeg_empty_lines = Ct ( ( lpeg_line_beamer * "\r" + P " " ^ 0 * "\r" * Cc ( 0 ) + ( 1 - P "\r" ) ^ 0 * "\r" * Cc ( 1 ) ) ^ 0 * ( lpeg_line_beamer + ( 1 - P "\r" ) ^ 1 * Cc ( 1 ) ) ^ -1 ) * -1 % \end{macrocode} % \begin{macrocode} local lpeg_all_lines = Ct ( ( lpeg_line_beamer * "\r" + ( 1 - P "\r" ) ^ 0 * "\r" * Cc ( 1 ) ) ^ 0 * ( lpeg_line_beamer + ( 1 - P "\r" ) ^ 1 * Cc ( 1 ) ) ^ -1 ) * -1 % \end{macrocode} % We begin with the computation of |piton.empty_lines|. It will be used in % conjonction with |line-numbers|. % \begin{macrocode} piton.empty_lines = lpeg_empty_lines : match ( code ) % \end{macrocode} % % Now, we compute |piton.lines_status|. It will be used in conjonction with % |splittable| and |splittable-on-empty-lines|. % % Now, we will take into account the current value of |\l_@@_splittable_int| % (provided by the \emph{absolute value} of the argument |splittable|). % \begin{macrocode} local lines_status local s = splittable if splittable < 0 then s = - splittable end % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} if splittable > 0 then lines_status = lpeg_all_lines : match ( code ) else % \end{macrocode} % Here, we should try to copy |piton.empty_lines| but it's not easy. % \begin{macrocode} lines_status = lpeg_empty_lines : match ( code ) for i , x in ipairs ( lines_status ) do if x == 0 then for j = 1 , s - 1 do if i + j > #lines_status then break end if lines_status[i+j] == 0 then break end lines_status[i+j] = 2 end for j = 1 , s - 1 do if i - j == 1 then break end if lines_status[i-j-1] == 0 then break end lines_status[i-j-1] = 2 end end end end % \end{macrocode} % % In all cases (whatever is the value of |splittable-on-empty-lines|) we have to % deal with both extremities of the listing to format. % % First from the beginning of the code. % \begin{macrocode} for j = 1 , s - 1 do if j > #lines_status then break end if lines_status[j] == 0 then break end lines_status[j] = 2 end % \end{macrocode} % Now, from the end of the code. % \begin{macrocode} for j = 1 , s - 1 do if #lines_status - j == 0 then break end if lines_status[#lines_status - j] == 0 then break end lines_status[#lines_status - j] = 2 end % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} piton.lines_status = lines_status end % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \subsubsection{To create new languages with the syntax of listings} % % \begin{macrocode} function piton.new_language ( lang , definition ) lang = string.lower ( lang ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % \begin{macrocode} local alpha , digit = lpeg.alpha , lpeg.digit local extra_letters = { "@" , "_" , "$" } -- $ % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % The command |add_to_letter| (triggered by the key ||) don't write right away % in the \textsc{lpeg} pattern of the letters in an intermediate |extra_letters| % because we may have to retrieve letters from that ``list'' if there appear in % a key |alsoother|. % \begin{macrocode} function add_to_letter ( c ) if c ~= " " then table.insert ( extra_letters , c ) end end % \end{macrocode} % % For the digits, it's straitforward. % \begin{macrocode} function add_to_digit ( c ) if c ~= " " then digit = digit + c end end % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % The main use of the key |alsoother| is, for the language LaTeX, when you have % to retrieve some characters from the list of letters, in particular |@| and % |_| (which, by default, are not allowed in the name of a control sequence in % TeX). % % \medskip % (In the following \textsc{lpeg} we have a problem when we try to add |{| and % |}|). % \begin{macrocode} local other = S ":_@+-*/<>!?;.()[]~^=#&\"\'\\$" -- $ local extra_others = { } % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} function add_to_other ( c ) if c ~= " " then % \end{macrocode} % We will use |extra_others| to retrieve further these characters from the list % of the letters. % \begin{macrocode} extra_others[c] = true % \end{macrocode} % The \textsc{lpeg} pattern |other| will be used in conjunction with the key % |tag| (mainly for languages such as \textsc{html} and \textsc{xml}) for the % character |/| in the closing tags ||). % \begin{macrocode} other = other + P ( c ) end end % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % Now, the first transformation of the definition of the language, as provided % by the final user in the argument |definition| of |piton.new_language|. % \begin{macrocode} local def_table if ( S ", " ^ 0 * -1 ) : match ( definition ) then def_table = {} else local strict_braces = P { "E" , E = ( "{" * V "F" * "}" + ( 1 - S ",{}" ) ) ^ 0 , F = ( "{" * V "F" * "}" + ( 1 - S "{}" ) ) ^ 0 } local cut_definition = P { "E" , E = Ct ( V "F" * ( "," * V "F" ) ^ 0 ) , F = Ct ( space ^ 0 * C ( alpha ^ 1 ) * space ^ 0 * ( "=" * space ^ 0 * C ( strict_braces ) ) ^ -1 ) } def_table = cut_definition : match ( definition ) end % \end{macrocode} % The definition of the language, provided by the final user of \pkg{piton} is % now in the Lua table |def_table|. We will use it \emph{several times}. % % \medskip % The following \textsc{lpeg} will be used to extract arguments in the values of % the keys (|morekeywords|, |morecomment|, |morestring|, etc.). % \begin{macrocode} local tex_braced_arg = "{" * C ( ( 1 - P "}" ) ^ 0 ) * "}" local tex_arg = tex_braced_arg + C ( 1 ) local tex_option_arg = "[" * C ( ( 1 - P "]" ) ^ 0 ) * "]" + Cc ( nil ) % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} local args_for_tag = tex_option_arg * space ^ 0 * tex_arg * space ^ 0 * tex_arg % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} local args_for_morekeywords = "[" * C ( ( 1 - P "]" ) ^ 0 ) * "]" * space ^ 0 * tex_option_arg * space ^ 0 * tex_arg * space ^ 0 * ( tex_braced_arg + Cc ( nil ) ) % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} local args_for_moredelims = ( C ( P "*" ^ -2 ) + Cc ( nil ) ) * space ^ 0 * args_for_morekeywords % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} local args_for_morecomment = "[" * C ( ( 1 - P "]" ) ^ 0 ) * "]" * space ^ 0 * tex_option_arg * space ^ 0 * C ( P ( 1 ) ^ 0 * -1 ) % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % We scan the definition of the language (i.e. the table |def_table|) in order % to detect the potential key |sensitive|. Indeed, we have to catch that key % before the treatment of the keywords of the language. We will also look for % the potential keys |alsodigit|, |alsoletter| and |tag|. % \begin{macrocode} local sensitive = true local style_tag , left_tag , right_tag for _ , x in ipairs ( def_table ) do if x[1] == "sensitive" then if x[2] == nil or ( P "true" ) : match ( x[2] ) then sensitive = true else if ( P "false" + P "f" ) : match ( x[2] ) then sensitive = false end end end if x[1] == "alsodigit" then x[2] : gsub ( "." , add_to_digit ) end if x[1] == "alsoletter" then x[2] : gsub ( "." , add_to_letter ) end if x[1] == "alsoother" then x[2] : gsub ( "." , add_to_other ) end if x[1] == "tag" then style_tag , left_tag , right_tag = args_for_tag : match ( x[2] ) style_tag = style_tag or [[\PitonStyle{Tag}]] end end % \end{macrocode} % Now, the \textsc{lpeg} for the numbers. Of course, it uses |digit| previously % computed. % \begin{macrocode} local Number = K ( 'Number.Internal' , ( digit ^ 1 * "." * # ( 1 - P "." ) * digit ^ 0 + digit ^ 0 * "." * digit ^ 1 + digit ^ 1 ) * ( S "eE" * S "+-" ^ -1 * digit ^ 1 ) ^ -1 + digit ^ 1 ) % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} local string_extra_letters = "" for _ , x in ipairs ( extra_letters ) do if not ( extra_others[x] ) then string_extra_letters = string_extra_letters .. x end end local letter = alpha + S ( string_extra_letters ) + P "â" + "à" + "ç" + "é" + "è" + "ê" + "ë" + "ï" + "î" + "ô" + "û" + "ü" + "Â" + "À" + "Ç" + "É" + "È" + "Ê" + "Ë" + "Ï" + "Î" + "Ô" + "Û" + "Ü" % \end{macrocode} % % \begin{macrocode} local alphanum = letter + digit local identifier = letter * alphanum ^ 0 local Identifier = K ( 'Identifier.Internal' , identifier ) % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % Now, we scan the definition of the language (i.e. the table |def_table|) for % the keywords. % % % The following LPEG does \emph{not} catch the optional argument between square % brackets in first position. % \begin{macrocode} local split_clist = P { "E" , E = ( "[" * ( 1 - P "]" ) ^ 0 * "]" ) ^ -1 * ( P "{" ) ^ 1 * Ct ( V "F" * ( "," * V "F" ) ^ 0 ) * ( P "}" ) ^ 1 * space ^ 0 , F = space ^ 0 * C ( letter * alphanum ^ 0 + other ^ 1 ) * space ^ 0 } % \end{macrocode} % The following function will be used if the keywords are not case-sensitive. % \begin{macrocode} local keyword_to_lpeg function keyword_to_lpeg ( name ) return Q ( Cmt ( C ( identifier ) , function ( s , i , a ) return string.upper ( a ) == string.upper ( name ) end ) ) end local Keyword = P ( false ) local PrefixedKeyword = P ( false ) % \end{macrocode} % Now, we actually treat all the keywords and also the key |moredirectives|. % \begin{macrocode} for _ , x in ipairs ( def_table ) do if x[1] == "morekeywords" or x[1] == "otherkeywords" or x[1] == "moredirectives" or x[1] == "moretexcs" then local keywords = P ( false ) % \end{macrocode} % \begin{macrocode} local style = [[\PitonStyle{Keyword}]] if x[1] == "moredirectives" then style = [[\PitonStyle{Directive}]] end style = tex_option_arg : match ( x[2] ) or style local n = tonumber ( style ) if n then if n > 1 then style = [[\PitonStyle{Keyword]] .. style .. "}" end end % \end{macrocode} % \begin{macrocode} for _ , word in ipairs ( split_clist : match ( x[2] ) ) do if x[1] == "moretexcs" then keywords = Q ( [[\]] .. word ) + keywords else if sensitive % \end{macrocode} % The documentation of \pkg{lstlistings} specifies that, for the key % |morekeywords|, if a keyword is a prefix of another keyword, then the prefix % must appear first. However, for the \text{lpeg}, it's rather the contrary. % That's why, here, we add the new element \emph{on the left}. % \begin{macrocode} then keywords = Q ( word ) + keywords else keywords = keyword_to_lpeg ( word ) + keywords end end end Keyword = Keyword + Lc ( "{" .. style .. "{" ) * keywords * Lc "}}" end % \end{macrocode} % Of course, the feature with the key |keywordsprefix| is designed for the % languages TeX, LaTeX, et \emph{al}. In that case, there is two kinds of % keywords (= control sequences). % \begin{itemize} % \item those beginning with |\| and a sequence of characters of catcode % ``|letter|''; % \item those beginning by |\| followed by one character of catcode ``|other|''. % \end{itemize} % The following code addresses both cases. Of course, the \textsc{lpeg} pattern % |letter| must catch only characters of catcode ``|letter|''. That's why we % have a key |alsoletter| to add new characters in that category (e.g. |:| when % we want to format L3 code). However, the \textsc{lpeg} pattern is allowed to % catch \emph{more} than only the characters of catcode ``other'' in TeX. % \begin{macrocode} if x[1] == "keywordsprefix" then local prefix = ( ( C ( 1 - P " " ) ^ 1 ) * P " " ^ 0 ) : match ( x[2] ) PrefixedKeyword = PrefixedKeyword + K ( 'Keyword' , P ( prefix ) * ( letter ^ 1 + other ) ) end end % \end{macrocode} % % % \bigskip % Now, we scan the definition of the language (i.e. the table |def_table|) for % the strings. % \begin{macrocode} local long_string = P ( false ) local Long_string = P ( false ) local LongString = P (false ) local central_pattern = P ( false ) for _ , x in ipairs ( def_table ) do if x[1] == "morestring" then arg1 , arg2 , arg3 , arg4 = args_for_morekeywords : match ( x[2] ) arg2 = arg2 or [[\PitonStyle{String.Long}]] if arg1 ~= "s" then arg4 = arg3 end central_pattern = 1 - S ( " \r" .. arg4 ) if arg1 : match "b" then central_pattern = P ( [[\]] .. arg3 ) + central_pattern end % \end{macrocode} % In fact, the specifier |d| is point-less: when it is not in force, it's still % possible to double the delimiter with a correct behaviour of \pkg{piton} % since, in that case, \pkg{piton} will compose \emph{two} contiguous strings... % \begin{macrocode} if arg1 : match "d" or arg1 == "m" then central_pattern = P ( arg3 .. arg3 ) + central_pattern end if arg1 == "m" then prefix = B ( 1 - letter - ")" - "]" ) else prefix = P ( true ) end % \end{macrocode} % First, a pattern \emph{without captures} (needed to compute |braces|). % \begin{macrocode} long_string = long_string + prefix * arg3 * ( space + central_pattern ) ^ 0 * arg4 % \end{macrocode} % Now a pattern \emph{with captures}. % \begin{macrocode} local pattern = prefix * Q ( arg3 ) * ( SpaceInString + Q ( central_pattern ^ 1 ) + EOL ) ^ 0 * Q ( arg4 ) % \end{macrocode} % We will need |Long_string| in the nested comments. % \begin{macrocode} Long_string = Long_string + pattern LongString = LongString + Ct ( Cc "Open" * Cc ( "{" .. arg2 .. "{" ) * Cc "}}" ) * pattern * Ct ( Cc "Close" ) end end % \end{macrocode} % The argument of |Compute_braces| must be a pattern \emph{which does no % catching} corresponding to the strings of the language. % \begin{macrocode} local braces = Compute_braces ( long_string ) if piton.beamer then Beamer = Compute_Beamer ( lang , braces ) end DetectedCommands = Compute_DetectedCommands ( lang , braces ) LPEG_cleaner[lang] = Compute_LPEG_cleaner ( lang , braces ) % \end{macrocode} % % \bigskip % Now, we deal with the comments and the delims. % \begin{macrocode} local CommentDelim = P ( false ) for _ , x in ipairs ( def_table ) do if x[1] == "morecomment" then local arg1 , arg2 , other_args = args_for_morecomment : match ( x[2] ) arg2 = arg2 or [[\PitonStyle{Comment}]] % \end{macrocode} % If the letter |i| is present in the first argument (eg: % |morecomment = [si]{(*}{*)}|, then the corresponding comments are discarded. % \begin{macrocode} if arg1 : match "i" then arg2 = [[\PitonStyle{Discard}]] end if arg1 : match "l" then local arg3 = ( tex_braced_arg + C ( P ( 1 ) ^ 0 * -1 ) ) : match ( other_args ) if arg3 == [[\#]] then arg3 = "#" end -- mandatory if arg3 == [[\%]] then arg3 = "%" end -- mandatory¨ CommentDelim = CommentDelim + Ct ( Cc "Open" * Cc ( "{" .. arg2 .. "{" ) * Cc "}}" ) * Q ( arg3 ) * ( CommentMath + Q ( ( 1 - S "$\r" ) ^ 1 ) ) ^ 0 -- $ * Ct ( Cc "Close" ) * ( EOL + -1 ) else local arg3 , arg4 = ( tex_arg * space ^ 0 * tex_arg ) : match ( other_args ) if arg1 : match "s" then CommentDelim = CommentDelim + Ct ( Cc "Open" * Cc ( "{" .. arg2 .. "{" ) * Cc "}}" ) * Q ( arg3 ) * ( CommentMath + Q ( ( 1 - P ( arg4 ) - S "$\r" ) ^ 1 ) -- $ + EOL ) ^ 0 * Q ( arg4 ) * Ct ( Cc "Close" ) end if arg1 : match "n" then CommentDelim = CommentDelim + Ct ( Cc "Open" * Cc ( "{" .. arg2 .. "{" ) * Cc "}}" ) * P { "A" , A = Q ( arg3 ) * ( V "A" + Q ( ( 1 - P ( arg3 ) - P ( arg4 ) - S "\r$\"" ) ^ 1 ) -- $ + long_string + "$" -- $ * K ( 'Comment.Math' , ( 1 - S "$\r" ) ^ 1 ) --$ * "$" -- $ + EOL ) ^ 0 * Q ( arg4 ) } * Ct ( Cc "Close" ) end end end % \end{macrocode} % For the keys |moredelim|, we have to add another argument in first position, % equal to |*| or |**|. % \begin{macrocode} if x[1] == "moredelim" then local arg1 , arg2 , arg3 , arg4 , arg5 = args_for_moredelims : match ( x[2] ) local MyFun = Q if arg1 == "*" or arg1 == "**" then function MyFun ( x ) if x ~= '' then return LPEG1[lang] : match ( x ) end end end local left_delim if arg2 : match "i" then left_delim = P ( arg4 ) else left_delim = Q ( arg4 ) end if arg2 : match "l" then CommentDelim = CommentDelim + Ct ( Cc "Open" * Cc ( "{" .. arg3 .. "{" ) * Cc "}}" ) * left_delim * ( MyFun ( ( 1 - P "\r" ) ^ 1 ) ) ^ 0 * Ct ( Cc "Close" ) * ( EOL + -1 ) end if arg2 : match "s" then local right_delim if arg2 : match "i" then right_delim = P ( arg5 ) else right_delim = Q ( arg5 ) end CommentDelim = CommentDelim + Ct ( Cc "Open" * Cc ( "{" .. arg3 .. "{" ) * Cc "}}" ) * left_delim * ( MyFun ( ( 1 - P ( arg5 ) - "\r" ) ^ 1 ) + EOL ) ^ 0 * right_delim * Ct ( Cc "Close" ) end end end local Delim = Q ( S "{[()]}" ) local Punct = Q ( S "=,:;!\\'\"" ) % \end{macrocode} % % % \begin{macrocode} local Main = space ^ 0 * EOL + Space + Tab + Escape + EscapeMath + CommentLaTeX + Beamer + DetectedCommands + CommentDelim % \end{macrocode} % We must put |LongString| before |Delim| because, in PostScript, the strings % are delimited by parenthesis and those parenthesis would be caught by |Delim|. % \begin{macrocode} + LongString + Delim + PrefixedKeyword + Keyword * ( -1 + # ( 1 - alphanum ) ) + Punct + K ( 'Identifier.Internal' , letter * alphanum ^ 0 ) + Number + Word % \end{macrocode} % % The \textsc{lpeg} |LPEG1[lang]| is used to reformat small elements, for % example the arguments of the ``detected commands''. % % Of course, here, we must not put |local|, of course. % \begin{macrocode} LPEG1[lang] = Main ^ 0 % \end{macrocode} % % % The \textsc{lpeg} |LPEG2[lang]| is used to format general chunks of code. % \begin{macrocode} LPEG2[lang] = Ct ( ( space ^ 0 * P "\r" ) ^ -1 * BeamerBeginEnvironments * Lc [[ \@@_begin_line: ]] * SpaceIndentation ^ 0 * ( space ^ 1 * -1 + space ^ 0 * EOL + Main ) ^ 0 * -1 * Lc [[ \@@_end_line: ]] ) % \end{macrocode} % % If the key |tag| has been used. Of course, this feature is designed for the % languages such as \textsc{html} and \textsc{xml}. % \begin{macrocode} if left_tag then local Tag = Ct ( Cc "Open" * Cc ( "{" .. style_tag .. "{" ) * Cc "}}" ) * Q ( left_tag * other ^ 0 ) -- $ * ( ( ( 1 - P ( right_tag ) ) ^ 0 ) / ( function ( x ) return LPEG0[lang] : match ( x ) end ) ) * Q ( right_tag ) * Ct ( Cc "Close" ) MainWithoutTag = space ^ 1 * -1 + space ^ 0 * EOL + Space + Tab + Escape + EscapeMath + CommentLaTeX + Beamer + DetectedCommands + CommentDelim + Delim + LongString + PrefixedKeyword + Keyword * ( -1 + # ( 1 - alphanum ) ) + Punct + K ( 'Identifier.Internal' , letter * alphanum ^ 0 ) + Number + Word LPEG0[lang] = MainWithoutTag ^ 0 local LPEGaux = Tab + Escape + EscapeMath + CommentLaTeX + Beamer + DetectedCommands + CommentDelim + Tag MainWithTag = space ^ 1 * -1 + space ^ 0 * EOL + Space + LPEGaux + Q ( ( 1 - EOL - LPEGaux ) ^ 1 ) LPEG1[lang] = MainWithTag ^ 0 LPEG2[lang] = Ct ( ( space ^ 0 * P "\r" ) ^ -1 * BeamerBeginEnvironments * Lc [[ \@@_begin_line: ]] * SpaceIndentation ^ 0 * LPEG1[lang] * -1 * Lc [[ \@@_end_line: ]] ) end end % % \end{macrocode} % % % % \vspace{1cm} % \section{History} % % The successive versions of the file |piton.sty| provided by TeXLive are available on the % \textsc{svn} server of TeXLive:\par\nobreak % % \smallskip % { % \small % \nolinkurl{https://tug.org/svn/texlive/trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/lualatex/piton/piton.sty} % } % % \medskip % The development of the extension \pkg{piton} is done on the following GitHub % repository: % % \verb|https://github.com/fpantigny/piton| % % \subsection*{Changes between versions 4.1 and 4.2} % % New key |break-numbers-anywhere|. % % \subsection*{Changes between versions 4.0 and 4.1} % % New language |verbatim|. % % New key |break-strings-anywhere|. % % \subsection*{Changes between versions 3.1 and 4.0} % % This version introduces an incompatibility: the syntax for the relative and % absolute paths in |\PitonInputFile| and the key |path| has been changed to be % conform to usual conventions. An temporary key |old-PitonInputFile|, available % at load-time, has been added for backward compatibility. % % New keys |font-command|, |splittable-on-empty-lines| and |env-used-by-split|. % % % \subsection*{Changes between versions 3.0 and 3.1} % % Keys |line-numbers/format|, |detected-beamer-commands| and % |detected-beamer-environments|. % % % \subsection*{Changes between versions 2.8 and 3.0} % % New command |\NewPitonLanguage|. Thanks to that command, it's now possible to % define new informatic languages with the syntax used by \pkg{listings}. % Therefore, it's possible to say that virtually all the informatic languages % are now supported by \pkg{piton}. % % \subsection*{Changes between versions 2.7 and 2.8} % % The key |path| now accepts a \emph{list} of paths where the files to include % will be searched. % % New commands |\PitonInputFileT|, |\PitonInputFileF| and |\PitonInputFileTF|. % % \subsection*{Changes between versions 2.6 and 2.7} % % New keys |split-on-empty-lines| and |split-separation| % % \subsection*{Changes between versions 2.5 and 2.6} % % API: |piton.last_code| and |\g_piton_last_code_tl| are provided. % % \subsection*{Changes between versions 2.4 and 2.5} % % New key |path-write| % % \subsection*{Changes between versions 2.3 and 2.4} % % The key |identifiers| of the command |\PitonOptions| is now deprecated and % replaced by the new command |\SetPitonIdentifier|. % % A new special language called ``minimal'' has been added. % % New key |detected-commands|. % % \subsection*{Changes between versions 2.2 and 2.3} % % New key |detected-commands| % % The variable |\l_piton_language_str| is now public. % % % New key |write|. % % \subsection*{Changes between versions 2.1 and 2.2} % % New key |path| for |\PitonOptions|. % % New language SQL. % % It's now possible to define styles locally to a given language (with the % optional argument of |\SetPitonStyle|). % % \subsection*{Changes between versions 2.0 and 2.1} % % The key |line-numbers| has now subkeys |line-numbers/skip-empty-lines|, % |line-numbers/label-empty-lines|, etc. % % The key |all-line-numbers| is deprecated: use % |line-numbers/skip-empty-lines=false|. % % New system to import, with |\PitonInputFile|, only a part (of the file) % delimited by textual markers. % % New keys |begin-escape|, |end-escape|, |begin-escape-math| and |end-escape-math|. % % The key |escape-inside| is deprecated: use |begin-escape| and |end-escape|. % % % % \tableofcontents % % \end{document} % % % Local Variables: % TeX-fold-mode: t % TeX-fold-preserve-comments: nil % flyspell-mode: nil % fill-column: 80 % End: